blob: 937f73aa748d8e15917eefa34c7e02f7eb845a3e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200907.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
917.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100608 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100610 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200611 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200613 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100616 - presetenv
617 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618 - uid
619 - ulimit-n
620 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200621 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100622 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200623 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-options
628 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-options
631 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100632 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200633 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100634 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100635 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100636 - 51degrees-data-file
637 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200638 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200639 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200640 - wurfl-data-file
641 - wurfl-information-list
642 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200643 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100644 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100647 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200648 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200650 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100651 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100652 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200654 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200655 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200656 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200658 - noepoll
659 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000660 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100662 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300663 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000664 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100665 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200666 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200667 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200668 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000669 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000670 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200671 - tune.buffers.limit
672 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200673 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200674 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100675 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100682 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100684 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100685 - tune.lua.session-timeout
686 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200687 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 - tune.maxaccept
689 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200690 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200691 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200692 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100697 - tune.sndbuf.client
698 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100699 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100700 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200701 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200703 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200704 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100705 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200706 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100707 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
709 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
710 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100711 - tune.zlib.memlevel
712 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714 * Debugging
715 - debug
716 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200717 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718
719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007203.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721------------------------------------
722
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200723ca-base <dir>
724 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100725 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
726 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
727 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729chroot <jail dir>
730 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
731 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
732 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
733 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
734 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100735 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100736
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100737cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
738 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
739 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
740 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
741 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
742 set. These sets have the format
743
744 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
745
746 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100747 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
749 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100750 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
751 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100752 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100753 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100754 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100755 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
757 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
758 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
759 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100760
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100761 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
762 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
763 on the machine's word size.
764
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100766 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
767 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
768 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
769 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
770 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
771 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772
773 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100774 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
775
776 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
777 # first 4 CPUs
778
779 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
780 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
781 # word size.
782
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100783 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100784 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100789 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
790 # and so on.
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100795 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100796 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
797 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
798 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
799
800 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
801 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
803
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100804 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
805 # and a thread range.
806 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
809
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200810crt-base <dir>
811 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100812 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
813 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200815daemon
816 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
817 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100818 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
819 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821deviceatlas-json-file <path>
822 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100823 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200824
825deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200827 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
828
829deviceatlas-separator <char>
830 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
831 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
832
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100833deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200834 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
835 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
836 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100837
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900838external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100839 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
840 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100841 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
842 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
843 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
844 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
845 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847gid <number>
848 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
849 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
850 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100851 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
852 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100854
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100855group <group name>
856 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
857 See also "gid" and "user".
858
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100859hard-stop-after <time>
860 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
861
862 Arguments :
863 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
864 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
865 SIGUSR1 signal.
866
867 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
868 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
869 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
870
871 Example:
872 global
873 hard-stop-after 30s
874
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200875h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
876 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
877 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
878 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
879 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500880 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200881 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
882 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
883 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
884 specified in a proxy.
885
886 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
887 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
888 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
889 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
890 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
891 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
892 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
893
894 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
895 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
896 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
897 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
898 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
899
900 Example:
901 global
902 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
903
904 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
905 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
906
907h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
908 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
909 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
910 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
911 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
912 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
913 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
914 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
915 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
916
917 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
918 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
919 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
920
921 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
922 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
923
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100924insecure-fork-wanted
925 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
926 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
927 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
928 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
929 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
930 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
931 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
932 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
933 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
934 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
935 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
936 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
937 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
938 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
939 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
940 disable it.
941
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100942insecure-setuid-wanted
943 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
944 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
945 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
946 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
947 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
948 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
949 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
950 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
951 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
952 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
953 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
954 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
955 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
956 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
957
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100958issuers-chain-path <dir>
959 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
960 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
961 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
962 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
963 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
964 "issuers-chain-path".
965 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
966 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
967 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
968 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
969 will share the chain in memory.
970
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200971log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
972 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100973 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100974 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100975 configured with "log global".
976
977 <address> can be one of:
978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100979 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100980 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
981 port).
982
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100983 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
984 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
985 port).
986
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100987 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
989 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100990 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100992 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
993 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
994 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
995 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
996 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
997 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
998 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
999 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1000 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1001 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1002 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1003 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1004 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1005 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1007 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001008
1009 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1010 "fd@2", see above.
1011
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001012 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1013 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1014 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1015 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1016 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1017
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001018 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1019 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001020
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001021 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1022 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1023 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1024 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1025 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1026 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1027 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1028 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1029 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1030 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1032 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001033
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001034 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1035 one of the following :
1036
1037 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1038 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1039
1040 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1041 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1042
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001043 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1044 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1045 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1046 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1047 logger consumes.
1048
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001049 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1050 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1051 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1052 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1053
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001054 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1055 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1056 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1057 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1058 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1059
1060 <sample_size>
1061 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1062 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1063 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1064 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1065 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1066
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001067 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001069 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1070 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1071 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1072
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001073 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1074 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1075 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1076 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077
1078 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001079 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1080 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1081 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1082 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1083 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1084 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001085
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001086 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001088log-send-hostname [<string>]
1089 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1090 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1091 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1092 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1093 the logs.
1094
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001095log-tag <string>
1096 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1097 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1098 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001099 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001100
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101lua-load <file>
1102 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1103 used multiple times.
1104
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001105lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1106 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1107 variable.
1108 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1109 to "path".
1110
1111 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1112 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1113 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1114 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1115 will be checked earlier.
1116
1117 As an example by specifying the following path:
1118
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1120 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1121
1122 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1124 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1125 paths if that does not exist either.
1126
1127 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1128 documentation.
1129
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001130master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001131 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1132 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1133 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001135 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1136 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001137 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1138 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1139 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1140 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1141 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001142
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001143 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001144
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001145mworker-max-reloads <number>
1146 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001147 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001148 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1149 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1150 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001152nbproc <number>
1153 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1154 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1155 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001156 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1157 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001158 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1159 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001160
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001161nbthread <number>
1162 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001163 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1164 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1165 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1166 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1167 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001168 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1169 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1170 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1171 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1172 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1173 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1174 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001178 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1179 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1180
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001181presetenv <name> <value>
1182 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1183 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1184 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1185 and "unsetenv".
1186
1187resetenv [<name> ...]
1188 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1189 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1190 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1191 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1192 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1193 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1194 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1195 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1196
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001197stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001198 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1199 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1200 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1201 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1202 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1203 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001204 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001205 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1206 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1207 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1208 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001209
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001210server-state-base <directory>
1211 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001212 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1213 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001214
1215server-state-file <file>
1216 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1217 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1218 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1219 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1220 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1221 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1222 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1223 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001224 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1225 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001226
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001227setenv <name> <value>
1228 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1229 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1230 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1231 and "unsetenv".
1232
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233set-dumpable
1234 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001235 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1236 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1237 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1238 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1239 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1240 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1241 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1242 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1243 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1244 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1245 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1246 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1247 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1248 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1249 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1250 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1251 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001252
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001253ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1255 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001256 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001257 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001258 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1259 information and recommendations see e.g.
1260 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1261 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1262 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1263 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001264
1265ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1267 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1268 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1269 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1270 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1272 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1273 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001274 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001275
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001276ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1278 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1279 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1280 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1281 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1282
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001283ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1284 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1285 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1286 keyword to see available options.
1287
1288 Example:
1289 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001290 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1294 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1301 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1302 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1303 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001304
1305ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1307 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1308 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1309 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1310 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001311 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1312 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1313 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1314 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001315
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001316ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1318 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1319 keyword to see available options.
1320
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001321ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1323 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1324 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001325 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001326 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001327 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1328 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1329 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1330 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001331 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1332 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1333 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1334
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001335ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001336 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1337 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1338
1339 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1340 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1341 optimize the startup time.
1342
1343 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1344 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1345 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1346
1347 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001348 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001349
1350 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1351 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1352 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1353 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1354 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1355 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001356 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001357 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1358
1359 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1360
1361 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1362
1363 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1364 not provided in the PEM file.
1365
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001366 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1367 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1368
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001369 The default behavior is "all".
1370
1371 Example:
1372 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1373 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1374 ssl-load-extra-files none
1375
1376 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1377
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001378ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1379 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1380 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1381 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1382
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001383ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1384 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1385 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1386 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1387 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1388 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1389 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1390 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1391 bits does not need it.
1392
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001393stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1394 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1395 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1396 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001397 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001398 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001399
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001400 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1401 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1402 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001403
1404stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1405 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1406 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001407 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001408
1409stats maxconn <connections>
1410 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1411 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1412
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001413uid <number>
1414 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1415 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1416 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1417 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1418
1419ulimit-n <number>
1420 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1421 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1422 option.
1423
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001424unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1425 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1426
1427 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1428 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1429 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1430 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1431 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1432 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1433 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1434 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1435 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1436 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1437
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001438unsetenv [<name> ...]
1439 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1440 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1441 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1442 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1443 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1444 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1445 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001447user <user name>
1448 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1449 See also "uid" and "group".
1450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001451node <name>
1452 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1453
1454 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1455 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1456 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1457 traffic.
1458
1459description <text>
1460 Add a text that describes the instance.
1461
1462 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1463 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1464 "<" and ">" characters.
1465
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146651degrees-data-file <file path>
1467 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001468 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001469
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001470 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001471 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1472
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001474 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1475 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1476 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1477
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001478 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001479 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1480
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001482 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1483 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1484
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001485 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1486 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1487
148851degrees-cache-size <number>
1489 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1490 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1491 By default, this cache is disabled.
1492
1493 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001494 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1495
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001496wurfl-data-file <file path>
1497 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1498 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1499
1500 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1501 with USE_WURFL=1.
1502
1503wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1504 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1505 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1506 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1507
1508 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1509
1510 Valid WURFL properties are:
1511 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1512
1513 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1514 device.
1515
1516 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1517 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1518
1519 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1520 particular web request.
1521
1522 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1523 used Libwurfl API version.
1524
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001525 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1526 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1527
1528 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1529 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1530
1531 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1532
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001533 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1534 with USE_WURFL=1.
1535
1536wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1537 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1538 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1539
1540 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1541 with USE_WURFL=1.
1542
1543wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1544 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1545 thus before the chroot.
1546
1547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001550wurfl-cache-size <size>
1551 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1552 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001553 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001554 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001555
1556 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1557 with USE_WURFL=1.
1558
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001559strict-limits
1560 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1561 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1562 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1563 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1564 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1565 keyword.
1566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015673.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001568-----------------------
1569
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001570busy-polling
1571 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1572 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1573 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1574 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1575 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1576 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1577 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1578 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1579 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1580 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1581 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1582 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1583 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1584 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1585 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1586 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1587 "poll" pollers.
1588
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001589 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1590 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1591 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1592
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001593max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1594 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1595 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1596 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1597 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1598 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1599 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1600 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1601 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603maxconn <number>
1604 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1605 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1606 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001607 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1608 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1609 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1610 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001611 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1612 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1613 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1614 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1615 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1616 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001618maxconnrate <number>
1619 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1620 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1621 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1622 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1623 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1624 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1625 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1626 fairness.
1627
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001628maxcomprate <number>
1629 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001630 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001631 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1632 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1633 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001634 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001635 default value.
1636
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001637maxcompcpuusage <number>
1638 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1639 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1640 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1641 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1642 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1643 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1644 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1645 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1646
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001647maxpipes <number>
1648 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1649 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1650 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1651 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1652 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1653 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1654
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001655maxsessrate <number>
1656 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1657 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1658 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1659 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1660 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1661 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1662 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1663 fairness.
1664
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001665maxsslconn <number>
1666 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1667 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1668 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1669 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1670 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1671 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1672 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001673 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1674 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1675 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1676 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1677 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1678 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1679 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001680
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001681maxsslrate <number>
1682 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1683 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1684 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1685 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1686 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1687 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1688 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1689 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1690 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1691 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1692
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001693maxzlibmem <number>
1694 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1695 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1696 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001697 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1698 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1699 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701noepoll
1702 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1703 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001704 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
1706nokqueue
1707 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1708 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1709 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1710
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001711noevports
1712 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1713 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1714 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1715 also "nopoll".
1716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717nopoll
1718 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1719 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001721 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1722 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001723
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001724nosplice
1725 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001727 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001728 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001729 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1730 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1731 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1732 "option splice-response".
1733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001734nogetaddrinfo
1735 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1736 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1737
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001738noreuseport
1739 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1740 command line argument "-dR".
1741
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001742profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1743 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1744 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1745 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1746 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001747 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001748 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1749 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1750 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1751 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1752
1753 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1754 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1755 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1756 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1757 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001758 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1759 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1760 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1761 CLI.
1762
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001763spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001764 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1765 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1766 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1767 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1768 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1769 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001771ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001772 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001773 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001774 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1775 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1776 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1777 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1778 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1780 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001781 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1782 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1783 openssl configuration file uses:
1784 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1785
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001786ssl-mode-async
1787 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001788 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001789 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1790 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1791 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001792 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001793 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001794
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001795tune.buffers.limit <number>
1796 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1797 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1798 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1799 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1800 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001802 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1803 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1804 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1805 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1806 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1807 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1808 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1809 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1810 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1811
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001812tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1813 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1814 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1815 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1816 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1817
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001818tune.bufsize <number>
1819 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1820 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1821 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1822 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1823 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1824 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1825 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001826 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1827 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1828 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001829 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001830 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1831 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1832 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001833
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001834tune.chksize <number>
1835 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1836 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1837 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1838 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1839 checks whenever possible.
1840
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001841tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1842 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1843 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1844 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1845 this value. The default value is 1.
1846
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001847tune.fail-alloc
1848 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1849 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1850 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1851 gracefully.
1852
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001853tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1854 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1855 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1856 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1857 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1858 change it.
1859
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001860tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1861 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1863 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001864 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1865 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1866 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1867 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1868 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1869
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001870tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1871 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1872 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1873 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1874 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1875 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1876 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1877 recommended not to change this value.
1878
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001879tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1880 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1881 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1882 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1883 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1884 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1885 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1886 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1887
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001888tune.http.cookielen <number>
1889 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1890 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1891 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1892 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1893 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1894 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1895 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1896 to change this value.
1897
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001898tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1900 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001901 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001902 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001903 configuration directives too.
1904 The default value is 1024.
1905
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001906tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1907 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1908 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1909 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1910 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1911 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1912 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001913 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1914 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1915 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001916
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001917tune.idletimer <timeout>
1918 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1919 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1920 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1921 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1922 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1923 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001924 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001925 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001926 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1927
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001928tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1929 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1930 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1931 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1932 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1933 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1934 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1935 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1936 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1937 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1938
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001939tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1940 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001941 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001942 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1943 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001944 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001945 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1946 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1947
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001948tune.lua.maxmem
1949 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1950 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1951 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1952 memory.
1953
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001954tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1955 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001956 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1957 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001958 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001959
1960tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1961 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1962 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1963 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1964 check servers.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001966tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1967 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1968 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1969 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001970 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001971
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001972tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001973 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1974 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1975 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1976 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1977 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1978 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1979 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1980 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1981 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1982 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001983
1984tune.maxpollevents <number>
1985 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1986 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1987 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1988 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1989 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1990
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001991tune.maxrewrite <number>
1992 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1993 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1994 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1995 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1996 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1997 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1998 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1999 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2000 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2001 bufsize.
2002
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002003tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2004 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2005 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2006 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2007 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2008 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2009 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2010 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2011 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2012 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002013 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2014 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002015 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2016 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2017 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2018 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2019 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2020 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2021 setting this parameter to 0.
2022
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002023tune.pipesize <number>
2024 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2025 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2026 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2027 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2028 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2029 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2030
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002031tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2032 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2033 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2034 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2035 default is 20.
2036
2037tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2038 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2039 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2040 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2041 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2042 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2043 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002044 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002045
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002046tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2047tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2048 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2049 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2050 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002051 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002053 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2054 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2055
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002056tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002057 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002058 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2059 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2060 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2061 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2062
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002063tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002064 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002065 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2066 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2067
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002068tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2069tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2070 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2071 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2072 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002073 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002074 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002075 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2076 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2077 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2078 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2079 notifying haproxy again.
2080
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002081tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002082 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2083 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2084 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002085 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002086 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002087 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002088 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2089 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2090 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002091 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2092 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002093
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002094tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002095 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002096 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2097 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2098 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2099 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2100 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2101
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002102tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2103 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002104 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002105 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2106 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2107 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2108 being used for too long.
2109
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002110tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2111 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2112 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2113 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2114 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2115 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2116 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2117 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2118 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2119 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2120 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002122 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002123
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002124tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2125 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2126 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2127 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2128 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2129 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2130 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2131 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002132 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2133 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002134
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002135tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2136 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2137 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2138 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2139 1000 entries.
2140
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002141tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2142 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2143 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2144 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2145
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002146tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002147tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002148tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2150tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002151 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2152 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2153 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2154 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2155 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2156 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2157 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2158 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002159
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002160 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2161 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2162 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2163 all available space is consumed.
2164 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2165 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2166 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002167
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002168tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2169 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002170 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002171 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002172 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002173 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2174
2175tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2176 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2177 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002178 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2179 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021813.3. Debugging
2182--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002183
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002184debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002185 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2186 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2187 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2188 system startup.
2189
2190quiet
2191 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2192 line argument "-q".
2193
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002194zero-warning
2195 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2196 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2197 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2198 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2199 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2200 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2201
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022033.4. Userlists
2204--------------
2205It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2206http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2207it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2208
2209userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002210 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002211 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2212
2213group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002214 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002215 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2216 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002218user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2219 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002220 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2221 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002222 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2223 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2224 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2225 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002226
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002227 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2228 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2229 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2230 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2231 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2232 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2233 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2234 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2235 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002236
2237 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002238 userlist L1
2239 group G1 users tiger,scott
2240 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002241
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002242 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2243 user scott insecure-password elgato
2244 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002245
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002246 userlist L2
2247 group G1
2248 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002249
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002250 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2251 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2252 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002253
2254 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002256
22573.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002258----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002259It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2260several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2261instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2262values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2263automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2264In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2265using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2266tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2267reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2268Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2269that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2270each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002271
2272peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002273 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002274 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2275
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002276bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2277 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2278 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2279
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002280disabled
2281 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2282 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2283 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2284
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002285default-bind [param*]
2286 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2287
2288default-server [param*]
2289 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2290
2291 Arguments:
2292 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2293 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2294 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2295 details.
2296
2297
2298 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2299
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002300enable
2301 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2302
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002303log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2304 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2305 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2306 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2307 more details.
2308
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002309peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002310 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2311 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2312 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2313 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2314 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2315 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2316
2317 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2318 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2319
2320 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2321 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2322 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2323 across all peers.
2324
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002325 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2326 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002327
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002328 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2329 "server" keyword explanation below).
2330
2331server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002332 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002333 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2334 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2335 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2336 of this "peers" section).
2337 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2338
2339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002340 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002341 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002342 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002343 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2344 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2345 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002346
2347 backend mybackend
2348 mode tcp
2349 balance roundrobin
2350 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2351 stick on src
2352
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002353 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2354 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002355
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002356 Example:
2357 peers mypeers
2358 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2359 default-server ssl verify none
2360 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2361 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002362
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002363
2364table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2365 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2366
2367 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2368 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002369 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002370 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2371 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2372 "stick-table" keyword).
2373
2374 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2375 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2376 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2377 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2378 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2379 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2380 of the stick-table name as follows:
2381
2382 peers mypeers
2383 peer A ...
2384 peer B ...
2385 table t1 ...
2386
2387 frontend fe1
2388 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2389
2390 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2391 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2392
2393 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2394 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2395 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2396 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2397 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2398 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2399 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2400
2401 peers mypeers
2402 peer A ...
2403 peer B ...
2404 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2405
2406 backend t1
2407 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2408
2409 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2410 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2411 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2412
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024133.6. Mailers
2414------------
2415It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2416If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2417in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2418
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002419mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002420 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2421 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2422
2423mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2424 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2425
2426 Example:
2427 mailers mymailers
2428 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2429 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2430
2431 backend mybackend
2432 mode tcp
2433 balance roundrobin
2434
2435 email-alert mailers mymailers
2436 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2437 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2438
2439 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2440 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2441
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002442timeout mail <time>
2443 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2444 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2445 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2446 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2447
2448 Example:
2449 mailers mymailers
2450 timeout mail 20s
2451 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002452
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024533.7. Programs
2454-------------
2455In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2456master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2457managed the same way as the workers.
2458
2459During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2460sequence as a worker:
2461
2462 - the master is re-executed
2463 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2464 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2465 instance of the program
2466
2467During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2468
2469program <name>
2470 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2471 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2472 the management guide).
2473
2474command <command> [arguments*]
2475 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2476 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2477 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2478 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2479
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002480user <user name>
2481 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2482 See also "group".
2483
2484group <group name>
2485 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2486 See also "user".
2487
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002488option start-on-reload
2489no option start-on-reload
2490 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2491 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2492 program section.
2493
2494
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024953.8. HTTP-errors
2496----------------
2497
2498It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2499imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2500several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2501
2502http-errors <name>
2503 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2504 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2505
2506errorfile <code> <file>
2507 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2508
2509 Arguments :
2510 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2511 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2512 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2513
2514 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2515 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2516 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2517 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2518 before any chroot is performed.
2519
2520 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2521
2522 Example:
2523 http-errors website-1
2524 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2525 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2526 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2527
2528 http-errors website-2
2529 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2530 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2531 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2532
2533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025344. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002535----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002537Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002538 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002539 - frontend <name>
2540 - backend <name>
2541 - listen <name>
2542
2543A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2544its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2545section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002547
2548A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2549connections.
2550
2551A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2552to forward incoming connections.
2553
2554A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2555parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2558'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2559case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2560
2561Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2562logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2563proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2564However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2565name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2566
2567Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2568and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002569bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2571modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2572arbitrary criteria.
2573
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002574In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2575a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002576the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002577
2578 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2579 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2580 between responses and new requests.
2581
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002582 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2583 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2584 client-facing connection remains open.
2585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002586 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2587 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002588
2589The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2590frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2591following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002592weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002593
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002594 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002595
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002596 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2597 ----+-----+-----+----
2598 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2599 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002600 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2601 ----+-----+-----+----
2602 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2607--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002609The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2610limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2611they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2612limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002613marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002614option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002615and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2616with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2617specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002619
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2621------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2622acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623backlog X X X -
2624balance X - X X
2625bind - X X -
2626bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002627capture cookie - X X -
2628capture request header - X X -
2629capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002630compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002631cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002632declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002633default-server X - X X
2634default_backend X X X -
2635description - X X X
2636disabled X X X X
2637dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002638email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002639email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002640email-alert mailers X X X X
2641email-alert myhostname X X X X
2642email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643enabled X X X X
2644errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002645errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002646errorloc X X X X
2647errorloc302 X X X X
2648-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2649errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002650force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002651filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652fullconn X - X X
2653grace X X X X
2654hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002655http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002656http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002657http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002658http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002659http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002660http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002661http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002662http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002663id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002664ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002665load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002666log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002667log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002668log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002669log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002670max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002671maxconn X X X -
2672mode X X X X
2673monitor fail - X X -
2674monitor-net X X X -
2675monitor-uri X X X -
2676option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2677option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2678option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2679option allbackups (*) X - X X
2680option checkcache (*) X - X X
2681option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2682option contstats (*) X X X -
2683option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2684option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002685-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2686option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002687option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2688option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002689option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002690option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002691option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002692option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002693option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002694option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2695option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2696option httpchk X - X X
2697option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002698option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002699option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002700option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002701option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002702option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002703option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2704option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2705option logasap (*) X X X -
2706option mysql-check X - X X
2707option nolinger (*) X X X X
2708option originalto X X X X
2709option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002710option pgsql-check X - X X
2711option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002712option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002713option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002714option smtpchk X - X X
2715option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2716option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2717option splice-request (*) X X X X
2718option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002719option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002720option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2721option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2722-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002723option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002724option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2725option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2726option tcpka X X X X
2727option tcplog X X X X
2728option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002729external-check command X - X X
2730external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002731persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2732rate-limit sessions X X X -
2733redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002734-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002735retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002736retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002737server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002738server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002739server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002740source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002741stats admin - X X X
2742stats auth X X X X
2743stats enable X X X X
2744stats hide-version X X X X
2745stats http-request - X X X
2746stats realm X X X X
2747stats refresh X X X X
2748stats scope X X X X
2749stats show-desc X X X X
2750stats show-legends X X X X
2751stats show-node X X X X
2752stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002753-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2754stick match - - X X
2755stick on - - X X
2756stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002757stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002758stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002759tcp-check connect X - X X
2760tcp-check expect X - X X
2761tcp-check send X - X X
2762tcp-check send-binary X - X X
2763tcp-check set-var X - X X
2764tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002765tcp-request connection - X X -
2766tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002767tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002768tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002769tcp-response content - - X X
2770tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002771timeout check X - X X
2772timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002773timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002774timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002775timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2776timeout http-request X X X X
2777timeout queue X - X X
2778timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002779timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002781timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002782transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002783unique-id-format X X X -
2784unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002786use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002787use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002788------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2789 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2793---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794
2795This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2796
2797
2798acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2799 Declare or complete an access list.
2800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2801 no | yes | yes | yes
2802 Example:
2803 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2804 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2805 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002807 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808
2809
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002810backlog <conns>
2811 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2813 yes | yes | yes | no
2814 Arguments :
2815 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2816 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002817 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002818
2819 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2820 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2821 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2822 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2823 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2824 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2825 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2826 backlog parameter.
2827
2828 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2829 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2830 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2831
2832 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2833
2834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002836balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002837 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2839 yes | no | yes | yes
2840 Arguments :
2841 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2842 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2843 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2844 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2845
2846 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2847 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2848 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2849 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002850 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002851 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002852 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2853 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2854 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2855 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2856 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2857 it, so that you don't worry.
2858
2859 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2860 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2861 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2862 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2863 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2864 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2865 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2866 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002868 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2869 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2870 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2871 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2872 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2873 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2874 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2875 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2876
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002877 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002878 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002879 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2880 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002881 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002882 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2883 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2884 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2885 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2886 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002887 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2888 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2889 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2890 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2891 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2892 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002893
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002894 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2895 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2896 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2897 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2898 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2899 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2900 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2901 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002902 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002903 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002904 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2905 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2906 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002907
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002908 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2909 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2910 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2911 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2912 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2913 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2914 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2915 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2916 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2917 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2918 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2919 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002920
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002921 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002922 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2923 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2924 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2925 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2926 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2927 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2928 URIs start with a leading "/".
2929
2930 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2931 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2932 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2933 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002936 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2937
2938 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002939 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2940 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002941 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2942 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2943 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2944 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002945 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002946 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2947 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002948
2949 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2950 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2951 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2952 server will receive the request.
2953
2954 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2955 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2956 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2957 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2958 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002959 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2960 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2961 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002963 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2964 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2965 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2966 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2967 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002969 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002970 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2971 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2972 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2973
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002974 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2975 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2976 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2977
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002978 random
2979 random(<draws>)
2980 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002981 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2982 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2983 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2984 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002985 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2986 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2987 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2988 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2989 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2990 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2991 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2992 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2993 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2994 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2995 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2996 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2997 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2998 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2999 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3000 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3001 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3002 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3003 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3004 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003005
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003006 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003007 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003008 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3009 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3010 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3011 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3012 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3013 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003014 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003015 used instead.
3016
3017 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3018 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3019 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3020 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3021
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003022 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3023 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3024 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3025
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003026 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003027
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003029 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3030 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003031
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003032 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3033 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3034 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003036 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003037 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003038 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3039 NTLM relies on.
3040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041 Examples :
3042 balance roundrobin
3043 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003044 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003045 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3046 balance hdr(host)
3047 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003048
3049 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3050 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003052 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003053 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3054 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3055 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003056 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003057
3058 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3059 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3060 defaults to 16 kB.
3061
3062 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3063 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3064
3065 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3066 Round Robin.
3067
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003068 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003069 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3070 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3071 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3072
3073 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3074
3075 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003076 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003077 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3078 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3079 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003080
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003081 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
3083
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003084bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3085bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3088 no | yes | yes | no
3089 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003090 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3091 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3092 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3093 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003094 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003095 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3096 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3097 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3098 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3099 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3100 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3101 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003102 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3103 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3104 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3105 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3106 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3107 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3108 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003109 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3110 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3111 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003112 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3113 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3114 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3115 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003116 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3117 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3118 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003119
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003120 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3121 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003122 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3123 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3124 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003125 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3126 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3127 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3128 the range.
3129
3130 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3131 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3132 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3133 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3134 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3135 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3136 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003137 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003138 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003140 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003141 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003142 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3143 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3144 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3145 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3146 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3147 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3148
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003149 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3150 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3151 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3152 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003153
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003154 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3155 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3156 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3157 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3158 in a frontend.
3159
3160 Example :
3161 listen http_proxy
3162 bind :80,:443
3163 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003164 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003166 listen http_https_proxy
3167 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003168 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003169
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003170 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3171 bind ipv6@:80
3172 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3173 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3174
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003175 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003176 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003177
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003178 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3179 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3180 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3181 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3182 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3183
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003184 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003185 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003186
3187
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003188bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003189 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3191 yes | yes | yes | yes
3192 Arguments :
3193 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3194 may be used to override a default value.
3195
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003196 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003197 option may be combined with other numbers.
3198
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003199 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003200 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3201 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3202 missing from all processes.
3203
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003204 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003205 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003206 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3207 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3208 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3209 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3210 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003211 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003212
3213 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3214 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3215 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3216 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3217 and 'even' instances.
3218
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003219 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3220 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3221 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3222 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003223
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003224 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3225 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3226
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003227 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3228 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3229 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3230
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003231 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3232 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3233
3234 Example :
3235 listen app_ip1
3236 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003237 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003238
3239 listen app_ip2
3240 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003241 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003242
3243 listen management
3244 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003245 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003246
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003247 listen management
3248 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3249 bind-process 1-4
3250
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003251 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003252
3253
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003254capture cookie <name> len <length>
3255 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 no | yes | yes | no
3258 Arguments :
3259 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3260 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3261 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3262 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003263 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003264
3265 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3266 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3267 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3268 right if it exceeds <length>.
3269
3270 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3271 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3272 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3273 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3274
3275 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3276 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3277 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3278
3279 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3280 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3281 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003282 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3283 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3284 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003285
3286 Example:
3287 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3288
3289 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003290 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291
3292
3293capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003294 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3296 no | yes | yes | no
3297 Arguments :
3298 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003299 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3301 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3302 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3303
3304 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3305 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3306 it exceeds <length>.
3307
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003308 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003309 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3310 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003311 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3312 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3313 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3314 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003315 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003316 environments to find where the request came from.
3317
3318 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3319 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3320 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3321 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003322
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003323 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3324 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3325 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3326 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3327 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328
3329 Example:
3330 capture request header Host len 15
3331 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003332 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003334 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003335 about logging.
3336
3337
3338capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003339 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3341 no | yes | yes | no
3342 Arguments :
3343 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003344 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3346 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3347 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3348
3349 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3350 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3351 it exceeds <length>.
3352
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003353 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003354 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3355 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3356 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003357 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3358 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3359 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3360 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003361
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003362 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3363 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3364 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3365 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3366 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367
3368 Example:
3369 capture response header Content-length len 9
3370 capture response header Location len 15
3371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003372 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373 about logging.
3374
3375
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003376compression algo <algorithm> ...
3377compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003378compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003379 Enable HTTP compression.
3380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3381 yes | yes | yes | yes
3382 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003383 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3384 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3385 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3386
3387 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003388 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3389 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3390 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003391
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003392 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003393 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003394
3395 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3396 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3397 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3398 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3399 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003400 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003401
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003402 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3403 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3404 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3405 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3406 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3407 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3408 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003409 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003410
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003411 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003412 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003413 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3414 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3415 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3416 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3417 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003418
3419 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3420 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3421 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3422 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3423 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003424 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3425 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3426 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3427 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3428 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003429 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3430 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003431
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003432 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003433 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3434 "Accept-Encoding" header
3435 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003436 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003437 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3438 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3439 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3440 "multipart"
3441 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3442 header
3443 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3444 and later
3445 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3446 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003447 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003448
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003449 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003450
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003451 Examples :
3452 compression algo gzip
3453 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003455
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003456cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003457 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3458 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003459 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3462 yes | no | yes | yes
3463 Arguments :
3464 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3465 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3466 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3467 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3468 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3469 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003470 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003471 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3472 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3473
3474 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3475 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3476 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3477 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3478 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3479 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003480 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3481 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003482 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003483 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3484 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
3486 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003487 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003488
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003489 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003490 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003491 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003492 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003493 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3494 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3495 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3496 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3497 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3498 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3499 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500
3501 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3502 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3503 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3504 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3505 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3506 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3507 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3508 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3509 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003510 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003511 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3512 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3513 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003515 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3516 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3517 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003518 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3519 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3520 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3521 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003522 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3523 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3524 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003525
3526 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3527 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3528 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3529 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3530 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3531 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3532 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3533 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3534 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3535
3536 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3537 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3538 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3539 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3540 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3541 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3542 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3543 persistence cookie in the cache.
3544 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3545
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003546 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3547 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3548 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3549 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3550 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003551 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003552 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3553 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3554 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3555 they logout.
3556
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003557 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3558 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3559 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3560 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3561
3562 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3563 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3564 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3565 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3566 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3567 this attribute.
3568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003569 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003570 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003571 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3572 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3573 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3574 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3575 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3576 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003577
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003578 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3579 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3580 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3581 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3582 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3583 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3584 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3585 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003586 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003587 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3588 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3589 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3590 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3591 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3592 the site.
3593
3594 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3595 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3596 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3597 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3598 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3599 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3600 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3601 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3602 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3603 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3604 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3605 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3606 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003607 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003608 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3609 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3610
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003611 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3612 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3613 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3614 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3615 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3616 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3617
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003618 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3619 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3620 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3621 repeated.
3622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003623 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3624 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3625 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3626 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 Examples :
3629 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3630 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3631 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003632 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003634 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003636
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003637declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3638 Declares a capture slot.
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 no | yes | yes | no
3641 Arguments:
3642 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3643
3644 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3645 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3646 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3647 for use in the response.
3648
3649 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003650 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003651 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3652
3653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003654default-server [param*]
3655 Change default options for a server in a backend
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | no | yes | yes
3658 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003659 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3660 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3661 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3662 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003663
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003664 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003665 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3666
3667 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003669
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670default_backend <backend>
3671 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3673 yes | yes | yes | no
3674 Arguments :
3675 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3676
3677 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3678 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3679 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3680 will catch all undetermined requests.
3681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003682 Example :
3683
3684 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3685 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3686 default_backend dynamic
3687
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003688 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003690
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003691description <string>
3692 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3694 no | yes | yes | yes
3695 Arguments : string
3696
3697 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3698 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3699 it describes.
3700 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3701
3702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003703disabled
3704 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3706 yes | yes | yes | yes
3707 Arguments : none
3708
3709 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3710 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3711 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3712 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3713 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3714 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3715 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3716
3717 See also : "enabled"
3718
3719
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003720dispatch <address>:<port>
3721 Set a default server address
3722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3723 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003724 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003725
3726 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3727 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3728 during start-up.
3729
3730 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3731 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3732 possible with normal servers.
3733
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003734 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003735 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3736 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3737 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3738 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3739
3740 See also : "server"
3741
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003742
3743dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3744 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3746 yes | no | yes | yes
3747 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3748
3749 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003750 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003751 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3752 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003753 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003754 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756enabled
3757 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | yes | yes | yes
3760 Arguments : none
3761
3762 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3763 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3764
3765 See also : "disabled"
3766
3767
3768errorfile <code> <file>
3769 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3771 yes | yes | yes | yes
3772 Arguments :
3773 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003774 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3775 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003776
3777 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003778 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003780 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3781 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782
3783 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3784 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3785 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3786
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003787 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003789 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3790 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3791 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3792 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3793
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003794 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3795 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003796 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003797 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3798 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3799 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3800
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003801 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3802 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3803 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003804 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003805 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3806
3807 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3808
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003809 Example :
3810 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003811 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003812 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3813 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3814
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003815
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003816errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3817 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3818 section.
3819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3820 yes | yes | yes | yes
3821 Arguments :
3822 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3823
3824 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3825 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3826 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3827
3828 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3829 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3830 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3831 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3832 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3833 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3834 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3835
3836 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3837 3.8 about http-errors.
3838
3839 Example :
3840 errorfiles generic
3841 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3842
3843
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003844errorloc <code> <url>
3845errorloc302 <code> <url>
3846 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3848 yes | yes | yes | yes
3849 Arguments :
3850 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003851 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3852 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003853
3854 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3855 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3856 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3857 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003858 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003859
3860 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3861 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3862 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3863
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003864 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3865
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003866 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3867 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3868 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3869 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003870 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003871 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3872 request.
3873
3874 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3875
3876
3877errorloc303 <code> <url>
3878 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 yes | yes | yes | yes
3881 Arguments :
3882 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003883 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3884 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003885
3886 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3887 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3888 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3889 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003890 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003891
3892 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3893 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3894 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3895
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003896 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3897
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003898 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3899 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3900 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3901 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003902 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003903
3904 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3905
3906
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003907email-alert from <emailaddr>
3908 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003909 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | yes | yes | yes
3912
3913 Arguments :
3914
3915 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3916
3917 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3918 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3919
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003920 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003921 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3922 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003923
3924
3925email-alert level <level>
3926 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3927 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | yes | yes | yes
3930
3931 Arguments :
3932
3933 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3934 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3935 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3936
3937 By default level is alert
3938
3939 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3940 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3941 for the proxy.
3942
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003943 Alerts are sent when :
3944
3945 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3946 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3947 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3948 is notice or lower
3949 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3950 and a health check status update occurs
3951
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003952 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3953 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003954 section 3.6 about mailers.
3955
3956
3957email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3958 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 yes | yes | yes | yes
3961
3962 Arguments :
3963
3964 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3965
3966 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3967 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3968
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003969 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3970 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003971
3972
3973email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3974 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3975 mailers.
3976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3977 yes | yes | yes | yes
3978
3979 Arguments :
3980
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003981 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003982
3983 By default the systems hostname is used.
3984
3985 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3986 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3987 for the proxy.
3988
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003989 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3990 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003991
3992
3993email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003994 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003995 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3997 yes | yes | yes | yes
3998
3999 Arguments :
4000
4001 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4002
4003 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4004 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4005
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004006 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004007 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4008
4009
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004010force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4011 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004013 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004014
4015 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4016 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4017 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4018 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4019 marked down for maintenance operations.
4020
4021 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4022 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4023 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4024 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4025 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4026 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4027 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4028 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4029 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4030
4031 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4032 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4033 is used.
4034
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004035 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004036 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004037
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004038
4039filter <name> [param*]
4040 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4042 no | yes | yes | yes
4043 Arguments :
4044 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4045 referenced in section 9.
4046
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004047 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004048 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004049 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4050 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004051
4052 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4053 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4054
4055 Example:
4056 listen
4057 bind *:80
4058
4059 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4060 filter compression
4061 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4062
4063 compression algo gzip
4064 compression offload
4065
4066 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4067
4068 See also : section 9.
4069
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004070
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004071fullconn <conns>
4072 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4074 yes | no | yes | yes
4075 Arguments :
4076 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4077 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4078
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004079 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004080 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004081 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004082 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4083 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4084 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4085 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4086 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004087 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004088
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004089 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4090 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004091 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4092 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4093 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004094
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004095 Example :
4096 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4097 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4098 # connections.
4099 backend dynamic
4100 fullconn 10000
4101 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4102 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4103
4104 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4105
4106
4107grace <time>
4108 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004110 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004111 Arguments :
4112 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4113 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4114 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4115
4116 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4117 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004118 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004119 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4120
4121 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4122 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4123 simplify it.
4124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004125
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004126hash-balance-factor <factor>
4127 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4129 yes | no | no | yes
4130 Arguments :
4131 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4132 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004133 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004134
4135 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4136 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4137 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4138 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4139 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4140 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4141 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4142
4143 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4144 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4145 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4146 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4147 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4148
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004149 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4150 consistent hashing mechanism.
4151
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004152 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4153
4154
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004155hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004156 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4158 yes | no | yes | yes
4159 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004160 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4161 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004162
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004163 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4164 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4165 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4166 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4167 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4168 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4169 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4170 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4171 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4172 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004173
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004174 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4175 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4176 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4177 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4178 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4179 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4180 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4181 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4182 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4183 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4184 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4185 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4186 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004187 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4188 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004189
4190 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4191
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004192 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004193 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4194 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4195 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004196 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4197 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4198 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004199
4200 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4201 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004202 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4203 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4204 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4205 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4206
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004207 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4208 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4209 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4210 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4211 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4212 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4213 parameter.
4214
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004215 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4216 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4217 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4218 used on strings.
4219
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004220 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4221
4222 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4223 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4224 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4225 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4226 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4227 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4228 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4229 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4230 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4231 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4232 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4233 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004234
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004235 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4236 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4237 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004238
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004239 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004240
4241
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004242http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4243 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4244 ones).
4245
4246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4247 no | yes | yes | yes
4248
4249 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4250 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4251 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4252 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4253 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4254 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4255
4256 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4257 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4258 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4259
4260 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4261 below.
4262
4263 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4264 instance.
4265
4266 Example:
4267 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4268 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4269 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4270
4271http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4272
4273 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4274 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4275 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4276 example, or to pass some internal information.
4277 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4278 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4279 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4280
4281http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4282
4283 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4284 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4285
4286http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4287
4288 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4289
4290http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4291 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4292
4293 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4294
4295 Example:
4296 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4297
4298 # applied to:
4299 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4300
4301 # outputs:
4302 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4303
4304 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4305
4306http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4307 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4308
4309 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4310
4311 Example:
4312 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4313
4314 # applied to:
4315 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4316
4317 # outputs:
4318 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4319
4320http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4321
4322 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4323 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4324 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4325
4326http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4327 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4328
4329 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4330 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4331 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4332 fallback.
4333
4334 Example:
4335 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4336 http-response set-status 431
4337 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4338 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4339
4340http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4341
4342 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4343 inline.
4344
4345 Arguments:
4346 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4347 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4348 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4349 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4350 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4351 (request and response)
4352 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4353 processing
4354 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4355 processing
4356 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4357 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4358 and '_'.
4359
4360 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4361 followed by some converters.
4362
4363 Example:
4364 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4365
4366http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4367
4368 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4369 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4370 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4371 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4372 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004373 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004374 processing.
4375
4376 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4377 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4378 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4379 rules evaluation.
4380
4381http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4382
4383 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4384 details about <var-name>.
4385
4386 Example:
4387 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4388
4389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004390http-check disable-on-404
4391 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004393 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004394 Arguments : none
4395
4396 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4397 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4398 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4399 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4400 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4401 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4402 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4403 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004404 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4405 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4406 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4407
4408 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4409
4410
4411http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004412 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004414 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004415 Arguments :
4416 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4417 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004418 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004419 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4420 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4421 details on the supported keywords.
4422
4423 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4424 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4425 with the usual backslash ('\').
4426
4427 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4428 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4429 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4430 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4431 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4432
4433 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004434 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004435 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4436 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4437 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4438
4439 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004440 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004441 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4442 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4443 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4444 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4445
4446 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004447 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004448 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4449 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4450 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4451 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4452 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004453 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004454 trace).
4455
4456 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004457 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004458 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4459 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4460 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4461 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4462 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004463 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004464
4465 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4466 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4467 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4468 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4469 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4470 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4471 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4472 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4473
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004474 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4475 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4476 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4477
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004478 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4479 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4480
4481 Examples :
4482 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004483 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004484
4485 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004486 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004487
4488 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004489 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004490
4491 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004492 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004493
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004494 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004495
4496
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004497http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4498 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4499 health checks.
4500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4501 yes | no | yes | yes
4502 Arguments :
4503 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4504 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4505 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4506
4507 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4508 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4509 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4510 to the request.
4511
4512 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4513 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4514 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4515 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4516 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4517 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4518 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4519 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4520
4521 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4522
4523
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004524http-check send-state
4525 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4527 yes | no | yes | yes
4528 Arguments : none
4529
4530 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4531 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4532 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4533 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4534 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4535
4536 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4537 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4538 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4539 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4540 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004541 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4542 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4543 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4544
4545 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4546 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4547 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4548
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004549 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4550 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4551 checked in multiple backends.
4552
4553 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4554 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4555
4556 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4557 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4558 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4559 one fails.
4560
4561 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4562 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4563 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4564
4565 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4566 server's queue.
4567
4568 Example of a header received by the application server :
4569 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4570 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4571
4572 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574
4575http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004576 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4577
4578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 no | yes | yes | yes
4580
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004581 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4582 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4583 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4584 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4585 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4588 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004590 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004592 Example:
4593 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4594 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4595 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004597 http-request allow if nagios
4598 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4599 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4600 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004602 Example:
4603 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4604 acl add path /addacl
4605 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004607 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4610 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004612 Example:
4613 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4614 acl setmap path /setmap
4615 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4620 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004622 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4623 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004627 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4628 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4629 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4630 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4631 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4632 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4633 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4634 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004636http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004638 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4639 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4640 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4641 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4642 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4643 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4644 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4645 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004647http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4650 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004651
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004653http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4656 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4657 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4658 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4659 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004661 Example:
4662 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4663 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004664
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004665http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004666
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004667 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4670 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004672 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4673 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4674 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4675 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4676 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4677 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4678 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4679 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4680 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004682 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4683 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4684 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004685 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4686
4687 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4688 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4689 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4690 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004692http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004694 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4695 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4696 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4697 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4698 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4699 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004701http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004703 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004705http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004707 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4708 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4709 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4710 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4711 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4712 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004713
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004714http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4715 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4718 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4719 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004720 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4721 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4722 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4723 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4724 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004725 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004726
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004727http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4728 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4729 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4730 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4731
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004732http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4733
4734 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4735 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4736 pointed by <resolvers>.
4737 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4738 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4739 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4740 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4741 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4742 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4743 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4744 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4745 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4746 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4747 to 0.0.0.0.
4748
4749 Example:
4750 resolvers mydns
4751 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4752 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4753 timeout retry 1s
4754 hold valid 10s
4755 hold nx 3s
4756 hold other 3s
4757 hold obsolete 0s
4758 accepted_payload_size 8192
4759
4760 frontend fe
4761 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4762 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4763 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4764
4765 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4766 # which mean DNS resolution error
4767 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4768
4769 default_backend be
4770
4771 backend b_503
4772 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4773 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4774 # 503 error page to end users
4775
4776 backend be
4777 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4778 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4779 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4780 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4781 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4782
4783 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4784 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4785
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004786http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4787
4788 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4789 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4790 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4791 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004792 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4793 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004794
4795 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4796
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004797http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004799 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4800 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4801 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4802 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4803 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004805http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004807 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4808 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4809 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4810 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004811
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004812http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4813 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004814
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004815 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004816 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4817 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4818 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4819 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4820 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004821
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004822 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4823 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4824 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4825 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4826 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004827
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004828 Example:
4829 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4830
4831 # applied to:
4832 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4833
4834 # outputs:
4835 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4836
4837 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004838
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004839 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4840
4841 # applied to:
4842 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004843
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004844 # outputs:
4845 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004846
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004847http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4848 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4849
4850 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4851 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4852 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4853 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4854
4855 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4856 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4857 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4858
4859 Example:
4860 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4861 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4862
4863 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4864 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4865
4866 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4867 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4868 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4869 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4870
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004871http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4872 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4873
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004874 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4875 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4876 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4877 against.
4878
4879 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4880 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4881 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004882
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004883 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4884 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4885 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4886 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4887 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4888 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4889 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4890 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4891 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004892 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4893 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004894
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004895 Example:
4896 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4897 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004898
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004899 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4900 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004902http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4903 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004904
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004905 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4906 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4907 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4908 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004909
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004910 Example:
4911 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004912
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004913 # applied to:
4914 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004915
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004916 # outputs:
4917 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004918
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004919http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4920 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4921 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004922 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004923 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4924
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004925 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004926 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4927 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4928 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4929 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004930 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004931 are followed to create the response :
4932
4933 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4934 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4935 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4936 ignored.
4937
4938 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4939 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4940 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4941 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4942 ignored.
4943
4944 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4945 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4946 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4947 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4948 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4949
4950 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4951 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4952 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4953 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4954 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4955 if any, is ignored.
4956
4957 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4958 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4959 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4960 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4961 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4962 as a raw content.
4963
4964 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4965 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4966 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4967 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4968 considered as a raw string.
4969
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004970 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4971 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4972 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4973 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4974
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004975 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4976 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4977 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4978
4979 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4980
4981 Example:
4982 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4983 if { path /ping }
4984
4985 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4986 if { path /favicon.ico }
4987
4988 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4989 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4990 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004992http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4993http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004994
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004995 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4996 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4997 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004998
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004999http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5000 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005001
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005002 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5003 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5004 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5005 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005006
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005007http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005009 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5010 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5011 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5012 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5013 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005014
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005015 Arguments:
5016 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5017 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005019 Example:
5020 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5021 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005023 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5024 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005026http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005027
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005028 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5029 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5030 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005032 Arguments:
5033 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5034 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005036 Example:
5037 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5038 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005040 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5041 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5042 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005044http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005046 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5047 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5048 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5049 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5050 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005052 Example:
5053 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5054 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5055 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5056 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5057 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5058 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5059 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5060 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5061 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005063http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005065 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5066 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5067 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5068 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5069 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005071http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5072 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005074 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5075 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5076 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5077 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5078 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5079 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5080 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5081 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5082 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005084http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005086 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5087 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5088 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5089 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5090 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5091 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5092 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005094http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5097 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5098 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005100http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005102 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5103 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5104 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5105 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5106 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5107 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5108 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5109 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005111http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005113 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5114 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5115 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5116 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5117 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5118 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005120 Example :
5121 # prepend the host name before the path
5122 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005124http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005126 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5127 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5128 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5129 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5130 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005132http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005134 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5135 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5136 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5137 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5138 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5139 values have higher priority.
5140 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5141 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5142 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5143 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5144 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005146http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005148 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5149 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5150 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5151 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5152 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5153 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5154 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005156 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005157
5158 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005159 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5160 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005162http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5163 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5164 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5165 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005166 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5167 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005168
5169 Arguments :
5170 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5171 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005172
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005173 See also "option forwardfor".
5174
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005175 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005176 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5177 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5178
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005179 # After the masking this will track connections
5180 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5181 http-request track-sc0 src
5182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005183 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5184 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5185
5186http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5187
5188 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5189 expression.
5190
5191 Arguments:
5192 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5193 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005194
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005195 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005196 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5197 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5198
5199 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5200 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5201 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5202
5203http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5204
5205 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5206 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5207 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5208 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5209 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5210 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5211 information from the request.
5212
5213 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5214
5215http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5216
5217 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5218 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5219 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5220 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5221 path and the query string.
5222 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5223
5224http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5225
5226 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5227 inline.
5228
5229 Arguments:
5230 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5231 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5232 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5233 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5234 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5235 (request and response)
5236 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5237 processing
5238 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5239 processing
5240 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5241 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5242 and '_'.
5243
5244 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5245 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005246
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005247 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005248 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005250http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5251 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005253 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5254 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5255 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5256 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5257 agent name must be used.
5258
5259 Arguments:
5260 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5261
5262 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5263 configuration.
5264
5265http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5266
5267 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5268 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5269 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5270 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5271 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5272 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5273 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5274 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5275 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5276 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5277 action.
5278 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5279 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5280 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5281 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5282 you fully understand how it works.
5283
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005284http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5285
5286 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5287 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5288 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5289 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5290 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005291 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005292 processing.
5293
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005294 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005295 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5296 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5297 rules evaluation.
5298
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005299http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5300 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005301
5302 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5303 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5304 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5305 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5306 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5307 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5308 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5309 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5310 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5311 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5312 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005313 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5314 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5315 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5316 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5317 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005318 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5319
5320http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5321http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5322http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5323
5324 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5325 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5326 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5327 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5328 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5329 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5330 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5331 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5332 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5333 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5334 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5335 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5336
5337 Arguments :
5338 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5339 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5340 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5341 select which table entry to update the counters.
5342
5343 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5344 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5345 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5346 that table until the session ends.
5347
5348 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5349 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5350 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5351 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5352 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5353 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5354 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5355 useful information.
5356
5357 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5358 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5359 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5360 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5361 checks that make use of it.
5362
5363http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5364
5365 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005366
5367 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005368 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005369
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005370http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5371
5372 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5373 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5374 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5375 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5376 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5377 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5378
5379 Arguments :
5380 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5381
5382 Example:
5383 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005385http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005387 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5388 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5389 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005390
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005391
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005392http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005393 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5394
5395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 no | yes | yes | yes
5397
5398 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5399 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5400 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5401 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5402 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5403 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5404
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005405 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5406 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005407
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005408 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005409
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005410 Example:
5411 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005412
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005413 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005414
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005415 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5416 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005418 Example:
5419 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005420
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005421 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005423 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5424 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005426 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5427 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005429http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005431 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5432 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5433 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5434 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5435 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5436 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5437 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5438 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005439
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005440http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005442 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5443 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5444 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5445 example, or to pass some internal information.
5446 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5447 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5448 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005450http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005451
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005452 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5453 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005454
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005455http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005456
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005457 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005459http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005461 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5462 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5463 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5464 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5465 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5466 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5467 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005468
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005469 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5470 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5471 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5472 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5473 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005474
5475 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5476 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5477 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5478 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005479
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005480http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005481
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005482 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5483 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5484 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5485 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5486 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5487 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005488
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005489http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005491 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005492
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005493http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005494
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005495 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5496 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5497 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5498 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5499 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5500 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005501
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005502http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5503 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005504
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005505 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005506 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5507 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005508 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5509 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5510 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5511 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5512 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005513 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005514
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005515http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005516
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005517 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5518 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5519 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5520 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5521 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5522 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005523
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005524http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5525 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005526
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005527 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5528 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005530 Example:
5531 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005532
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005533 # applied to:
5534 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005535
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005536 # outputs:
5537 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005538
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005539 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005540
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005541http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5542 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005543
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005544 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005545 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005546
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005547 Example:
5548 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005549
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005550 # applied to:
5551 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005552
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005553 # outputs:
5554 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005555
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005556http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5557 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5558 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005559 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005560 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5561
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005562 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005563 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5564 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5565 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5566 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005567 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005568 are followed to create the response :
5569
5570 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5571 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5572 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5573 ignored.
5574
5575 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5576 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5577 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5578 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5579 ignored.
5580
5581 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5582 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5583 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5584 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5585 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5586
5587 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5588 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5589 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5590 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5591 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5592 if any, is ignored.
5593
5594 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5595 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5596 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5597 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5598 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5599 as a raw content.
5600
5601 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5602 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5603 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5604 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5605 considered as a raw string.
5606
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005607 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5608 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5609 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5610 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5611
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005612 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5613 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5614 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5615
5616 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5617
5618 Example:
5619 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5620 if { status eq 404 }
5621
5622 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5623 string "This is the end !" \
5624 if { status eq 500 }
5625
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005626http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5627http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005628
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005629 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5630 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5631 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005632
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005633http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5634 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005635
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005636 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5637 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5638 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5639 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005640
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005641http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005642
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005643 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5644 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5645 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5646 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5647 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005648
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005649 Arguments:
5650 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005651
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005652 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5653 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005654
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005655http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005657 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5658 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5659 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005661http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5662
5663 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5664 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5665 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5666 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5667 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5668
5669http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5670
5671 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5672 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5673 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5674 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5675 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5676 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5677 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5678 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5679 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5680
5681http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5682
5683 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5684 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5685 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5686 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5687 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5688 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5689 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5690
5691http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5692
5693 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5694 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5695 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5696 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5697 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5698 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5699 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5700 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5701
5702http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5703 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5704
5705 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5706 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5707 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5708 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005709
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005710 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005711 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5712 http-response set-status 431
5713 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5714 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005715
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005716http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005718 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5719 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5720 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5721 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5722 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5723 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5724 based on some information from the request.
5725
5726 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5727
5728http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5729
5730 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5731 inline.
5732
5733 Arguments:
5734 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5735 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5736 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5737 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5738 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5739 (request and response)
5740 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5741 processing
5742 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5743 processing
5744 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5745 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5746 and '_'.
5747
5748 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5749 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005750
5751 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005752 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005754http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005755
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005756 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5757 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5758 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5759 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5760 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5761 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5762 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5763 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5764 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5765 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5766 action.
5767 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5768 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5769 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5770 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5771 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005772
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005773http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5774
5775 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5776 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5777 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5778 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5779 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005780 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005781 processing.
5782
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005783 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005784 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5785 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5786 rules evaluation.
5787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005788http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5789http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5790http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005792 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5793 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5794 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5795 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5796 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5797 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5798
5799http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5800
5801 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5802 about <var-name>.
5803
5804 Example:
5805 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5806
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005807
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005808http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5809 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5810
5811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5812 yes | no | yes | yes
5813
5814 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005815 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5816 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5817 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005818
5819 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5820
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005821 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5822 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5823 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5824 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5825 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5826 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5827 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5828 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5829 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5830 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005831
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005832 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5833 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5834 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5835 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5836 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5837 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5838 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5839 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005840
5841 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5842 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5843 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5844 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5845 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5846 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5847 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5848 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005849 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005850 downsides of rare connection failures.
5851
5852 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5853 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5854 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5855 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5856 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5857 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005858 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005859 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5860 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5861 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5862 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5863 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5864
5865 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005866 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5867 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5868 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005869
5870 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005871 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005872
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005873 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5874 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005875
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005876 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005877
5878 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5879 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5880 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5881
5882 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5883
5884
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005885http-send-name-header [<header>]
5886 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005889 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005890 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5891
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005892 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5893 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5894 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5895 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5896 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5897 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5898 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5899 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5900 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5901 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5902 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5903 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5904 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5905 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5906 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5907 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005908
5909 See also : "server"
5910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005911id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005912 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5914 no | yes | yes | yes
5915 Arguments : none
5916
5917 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5918 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5919 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005920
5921
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005922ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5923 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005925 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005926
5927 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5928 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5929 and running).
5930
5931 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5932 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5933 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005934 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005935 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5936
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005937 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5938 "unless" condition is met.
5939
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005940 Example:
5941 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5942 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5943 ignore-persist if url_static
5944
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005945 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5946
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005947load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5948 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5950 yes | no | yes | yes
5951
5952 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5953 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5954 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005955 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005956 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5957 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5958 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5959 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5960
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005961 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005962 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005963 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005964
5965 Arguments:
5966 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5967 named "server-state-file".
5968
5969 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5970 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5971 name is used as a file name.
5972
5973 none don't load any stat for this backend
5974
5975 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005976 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5977 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5978 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005979 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005980 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005981
5982 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5983 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5984
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005985 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005986
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005987 global
5988 stats socket /tmp/socket
5989 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005990
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005991 defaults
5992 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005993
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005994 backend bk
5995 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5996 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005997
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005998
5999 Then one can run :
6000
6001 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6002
6003 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6004
6005 1
6006 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6007 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6008 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6009
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006010 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006011
6012 global
6013 stats socket /tmp/socket
6014 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6015
6016 defaults
6017 load-server-state-from-file local
6018
6019 backend bk
6020 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6021 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6022
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006023
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006024 Then one can run :
6025
6026 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6027
6028 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6029
6030 1
6031 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6032 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6033 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6034
6035 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6036 "show servers state"
6037
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006038
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006039log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006040log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6041 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006042no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006043 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6045 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006046
6047 Prefix :
6048 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6049 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6050 prefix does not allow arguments.
6051
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006052 Arguments :
6053 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6054 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6055 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6056 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6057 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6058 parameter.
6059
6060 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6061 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6062
6063 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6064 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6065 standard syslog port).
6066
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006067 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6068 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6069 standard syslog port).
6070
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006071 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6072 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6073 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006074 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006075
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006076 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6077 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6078 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6079 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6080 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6081 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6082 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6083 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6084 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6085 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6086 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6087 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6088 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6089 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6090 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6091 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006092 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6093 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006094
6095 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6096 and "fd@2", see above.
6097
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006098 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6099 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6100 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6101 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6102 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6103 having the logs instantly available.
6104
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006105 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6106 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006107
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006108 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6109 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6110 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6111 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6112 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6113 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6114 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6115 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6116 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6117 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006118 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006119
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006120 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6121 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6122 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6123 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6124 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6125
6126 <sample_size>
6127 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6128 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6129 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6130 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6131 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6132
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006133 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6134 one of the following :
6135
6136 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6137 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6138
6139 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6140 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6141
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006142 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6143 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6144 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6145 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6146 systemd logger consumes.
6147
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006148 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6149 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6150 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6151 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6152
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006153 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6154
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006155 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6156 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6157 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6158
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006159 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6160 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6161 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6162 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006163
6164 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6165 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6166 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006167 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6168 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6169 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6170 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6171 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006172
6173 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6174
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006175 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6176 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6177 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006178
6179 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6180 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6181 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6182 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6183
6184 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6185 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006186
6187 Example :
6188 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006189 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6190 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6191 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006192 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6193 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006194 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006195
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006196
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006197log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006198 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6199 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6200 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006201
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006202 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6203 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6204 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6205 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6206 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006207
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006208 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6209 "option httplog" directives.
6210
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006211log-format-sd <string>
6212 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6214 yes | yes | yes | no
6215
6216 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6217 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6218 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6219 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6220 which covers the log format string in depth.
6221
6222 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6223 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6224
6225 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6226 log format to "rfc5424".
6227
6228 Example :
6229 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6230
6231
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006232log-tag <string>
6233 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6235 yes | yes | yes | yes
6236
6237 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6238 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6239 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6240 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6241 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6242 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6243 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6244 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6245 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006246
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006247max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6248 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6249 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6250 yes | no | yes | yes
6251
6252 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6253 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6254 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6255 servers.
6256
6257 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6258 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6259 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6260 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6261 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006262 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006263 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6264 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6265 picking a different server.
6266
6267 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6268 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6269 even if they have to be queued.
6270
6271 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6272 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6273
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006274max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6275 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6276 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6277 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006278
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006279maxconn <conns>
6280 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6282 yes | yes | yes | no
6283 Arguments :
6284 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6285 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6286 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6287 closes.
6288
6289 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6290 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6291 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6292 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006293 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6294 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6295 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6296 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006297
6298 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6299 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6300 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6301
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006302 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6303 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006304
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006305 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6306
6307
6308mode { tcp|http|health }
6309 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6311 yes | yes | yes | yes
6312 Arguments :
6313 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6314 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6315 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6316 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6317
6318 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6319 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6320 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6321 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6322 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6323
6324 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006325 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6326 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6327 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6328 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6329 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6330 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6331 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006332
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006333 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6334 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6335 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006336
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006337 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006338 defaults http_instances
6339 mode http
6340
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006341 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006342
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006343
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006344monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006345 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6347 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006348 Arguments :
6349 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6350 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006351 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006352 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6353 backend and its backup.
6354
6355 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6356 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6357 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6358 servers in a list of backends.
6359
6360 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6361 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6362 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6363 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6364 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6365 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6366 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006367 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6368 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006369
6370 Example:
6371 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006372 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006373 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6374 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6375 monitor-uri /site_alive
6376 monitor fail if site_dead
6377
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006378 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006379
6380
6381monitor-net <source>
6382 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6384 yes | yes | yes | no
6385 Arguments :
6386 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6387 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6388 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6389 followed by a mask.
6390
6391 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6392 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006393 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006394 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6395
6396 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6397 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6398 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6399 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006400 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6401 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6402 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006403
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006404 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6405 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6406 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6407 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6408 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6409 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006410
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006411 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6412 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006413
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006414 Example :
6415 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6416 frontend www
6417 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6418
6419 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6420
6421
6422monitor-uri <uri>
6423 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 yes | yes | yes | no
6426 Arguments :
6427 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6428 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6429
6430 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6431 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6432 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6433 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6434 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6435 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6436 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6437 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6438
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006439 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006440 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6441 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6442 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6443 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6444 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6445 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006446
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006447 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6448 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6449 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6450 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6451
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006452 Example :
6453 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6454 frontend www
6455 mode http
6456 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6457
6458 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006460
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006461option abortonclose
6462no option abortonclose
6463 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6465 yes | no | yes | yes
6466 Arguments : none
6467
6468 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6469 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6470 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6471 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006472 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006473 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6474 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6475 encountered while delivering the response.
6476
6477 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6478 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6479 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6480 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6481 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6482 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006483 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006484 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006485 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006486 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6487 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6488 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6489
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006490 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6491 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006492 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6493 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6494 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6495 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6496 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6497 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006498 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006499
6500 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6501 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6502
6503 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6504
6505
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006506option accept-invalid-http-request
6507no option accept-invalid-http-request
6508 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6510 yes | yes | yes | no
6511 Arguments : none
6512
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006513 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006514 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006515 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006516 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6517 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6518 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6519 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6520 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006521 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6522 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6523 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6524 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006525 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006526 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006527 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6528 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6529 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006530
6531 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6532 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6533 been confirmed.
6534
6535 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6536 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006537 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6538 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006539 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6540
6541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6543
6544 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6545 stats socket.
6546
6547
6548option accept-invalid-http-response
6549no option accept-invalid-http-response
6550 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6552 yes | no | yes | yes
6553 Arguments : none
6554
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006555 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006556 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006557 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006558 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6559 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6560 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6561 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6562 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006563 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6564 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6565 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006566
6567 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6568 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6569 been confirmed.
6570
6571 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6572 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6573 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6574 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6575
6576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6578
6579 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6580 stats socket.
6581
6582
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006583option allbackups
6584no option allbackups
6585 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | no | yes | yes
6588 Arguments : none
6589
6590 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6591 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6592 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6593 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6594 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6595 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6596 order between the backup servers anymore.
6597
6598 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6599 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6600
6601 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6602 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6603
6604
6605option checkcache
6606no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006607 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6609 yes | no | yes | yes
6610 Arguments : none
6611
6612 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6613 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006614 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006615 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6616 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006617 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006618
6619 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006620 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006621 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006622 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6623 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006624 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006625 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006626 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6627 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006628 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006629 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6630 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006631 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006632 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6633 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6634 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6635 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6636 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6637 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6638 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6639 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6640 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6641
6642 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006643 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6644 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6645 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6646 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006647
6648 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6649 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006650 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006651 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006652
6653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6655
6656
6657option clitcpka
6658no option clitcpka
6659 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6661 yes | yes | yes | no
6662 Arguments : none
6663
6664 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6665 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006666 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006667 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6668
6669 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6670 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6671 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6672 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6673
6674 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6675 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6676 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6677 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6678 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6679
6680 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6681
6682 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6683 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6684 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6685
6686 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6687 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6688
6689 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6690
6691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006692option contstats
6693 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6695 yes | yes | yes | no
6696 Arguments : none
6697
6698 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6699 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6700 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6701 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006702 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6703 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6704 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6705 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6706 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006707
6708
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006709option dontlog-normal
6710no option dontlog-normal
6711 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6713 yes | yes | yes | no
6714 Arguments : none
6715
6716 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6717 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6718 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6719 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6720 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6721 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6722 logged.
6723
6724 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6725 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6726 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006728 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006729 logging.
6730
6731
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006732option dontlognull
6733no option dontlognull
6734 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6736 yes | yes | yes | no
6737 Arguments : none
6738
6739 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6740 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6741 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6742 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6743 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6744 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006745 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6746 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6747 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006748
6749 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006750 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006751 would not be logged.
6752
6753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6755
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006756 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6757 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006758
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006759
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006760option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006761 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6763 yes | yes | yes | yes
6764 Arguments :
6765 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6766 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006767 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006768 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006769
6770 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6771 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6772 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6773 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6774 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6775 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6776 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006777 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6778 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6779 possible that the client has already brought one.
6780
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006781 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006782 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006783 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006784 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006785 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006786 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006787
6788 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6789 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6790 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6791 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6792 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6793 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6794 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6795
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006796 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6797 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6798 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6799 are under the control of the end-user.
6800
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006801 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006802 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6803 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006804 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6805 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6806 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006807
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006808 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006809 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6810 frontend www
6811 mode http
6812 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6813
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006814 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6815 backend www
6816 mode http
6817 option forwardfor header X-Client
6818
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006819 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006820 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006821
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006822
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006823option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6824no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6825 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6827 yes | yes | yes | no
6828 Arguments : none
6829
6830 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6831 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6832 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6833 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6834 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6835 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6836 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6837
6838 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6839 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6840 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6841 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6842 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6843 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6844 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6845 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6846 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6847 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6848
6849 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6850
6851 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6852 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6853
6854 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6855 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6856
6857
6858option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6859no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6860 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6862 yes | no | yes | yes
6863 Arguments : none
6864
6865 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6866 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6867 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6868 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6869 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6870 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6871 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6872
6873 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6874 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6875 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6876 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6877 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6878 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6879 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6880 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6881 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6882 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6883
6884 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6885
6886 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6887 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6888
6889 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6890 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6891
6892
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006893option http-buffer-request
6894no option http-buffer-request
6895 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6897 yes | yes | yes | yes
6898 Arguments : none
6899
6900 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6901 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6902 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6903 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6904 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6905 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006906 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6907 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6908 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6909 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006910
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006911 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006912
6913
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006914option http-ignore-probes
6915no option http-ignore-probes
6916 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 yes | yes | yes | no
6919 Arguments : none
6920
6921 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6922 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6923 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6924 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6925 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6926 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6927 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6928 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6929 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006930 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6931 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006932 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6933
6934 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6935 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6936 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6937 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6938 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6939 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6940 are often the only way to detect them.
6941
6942 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6943 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6944
6945 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6946
6947
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006948option http-keep-alive
6949no option http-keep-alive
6950 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6952 yes | yes | yes | yes
6953 Arguments : none
6954
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006955 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6956 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006957 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6958 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006959 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6960 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6961 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006962
6963 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6964 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006965 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6966 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6967 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6968 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6969 situations where this option may be useful :
6970
6971 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006972 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006973
6974 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6975 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6976
6977 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6978 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6979 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6980 request.
6981
6982 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6983 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006984 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6985 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6986 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006987
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006988 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6989 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6990 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6991 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6992 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6993 not set.
6994
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006995 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6996 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6997 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006998
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006999 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007000 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007001 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007002
7003
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007004option http-no-delay
7005no option http-no-delay
7006 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7008 yes | yes | yes | yes
7009 Arguments : none
7010
7011 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7012 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7013 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7014 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7015 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7016 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7017 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7018 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7019 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7020 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7021 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7022 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7023 affected.
7024
7025 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7026 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7027 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7028 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7029 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7030 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7031 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7032 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7033 latency environments.
7034
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007035 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7036
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007037
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007038option http-pretend-keepalive
7039no option http-pretend-keepalive
7040 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007042 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007043 Arguments : none
7044
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007045 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007046 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7047 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7048 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7049 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7050 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7051 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7052 consider the response complete.
7053
7054 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7055 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7056 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7057 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007058 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007059 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7060
7061 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7062 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7063 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7064 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7065 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7066 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7067 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7068
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007069 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7070 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7071 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7072 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7073 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7074 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007075
7076 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7077 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7078
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007079 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007080 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007081
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007082
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007083option http-server-close
7084no option http-server-close
7085 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7087 yes | yes | yes | yes
7088 Arguments : none
7089
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007090 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7091 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7092 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7093 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007094 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7095 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7096 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7097 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7098 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7099 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7100 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7101 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7102 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7103 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7104 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007105
7106 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7107 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7108 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7109 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007110 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7111 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007112
7113 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7114 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007115 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7116 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7117 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007118
7119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7121
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007122 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7123 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007124
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007125option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007126no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007127 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7129 yes | yes | yes | no
7130 Arguments : none
7131
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007132 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007133 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7134 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7135 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7136 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7137 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7138 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7139
7140 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7141 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007142 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7143 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7144 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007145
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007146 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7147 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7148 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7149 front of an existing proxy.
7150
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007151 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7152
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007153 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007154
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007155option httpchk
7156option httpchk <uri>
7157option httpchk <method> <uri>
7158option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7159 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7161 yes | no | yes | yes
7162 Arguments :
7163 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7164 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7165 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7166 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7167 ones.
7168
7169 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7170 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7171 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7172
7173 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7174 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7175 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007176 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007177
7178 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7179 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7180 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7181 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7182 the lack of any response.
7183
7184 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7185
7186 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7187 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7188 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7189
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007190 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7191 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7192 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7193 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7194
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007195 Examples :
7196 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7197 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7198 backend https_relay
7199 mode tcp
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007200 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7201 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007202 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7203
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007204 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7205 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7206 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007207
7208
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007209option httpclose
7210no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007211 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7213 yes | yes | yes | yes
7214 Arguments : none
7215
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007216 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7217 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7218 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7219 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007220 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007221
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007222 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7223 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007224 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007225 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7226 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007227
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007228 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7229 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7230 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007231
7232 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7233 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007234 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7235 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7236 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007237
7238 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7239 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7240
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007241 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007242
7243
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007244option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007245 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007247 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007248 Arguments :
7249 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7250 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7251 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007252 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007253 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007254
7255 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7256 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7257 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7258 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7259 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7260 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7261 ports.
7262
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007263 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7264 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007265
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007266 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007268 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007269
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007270
7271option http_proxy
7272no option http_proxy
7273 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7275 yes | yes | yes | yes
7276 Arguments : none
7277
7278 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7279 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7280 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7281 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7282 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7283
7284 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7285 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007286 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7287 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007288
7289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7291
7292 Example :
7293 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7294 backend direct_forward
7295 option httpclose
7296 option http_proxy
7297
7298 See also : "option httpclose"
7299
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007300
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007301option independent-streams
7302no option independent-streams
7303 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7305 yes | yes | yes | yes
7306 Arguments : none
7307
7308 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7309 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7310 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7311 receive data or not.
7312
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007313 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007314 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7315 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7316 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7317 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7318 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7319 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7320 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7321 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7322 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7323 socket buffers.
7324
7325 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7326 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7327 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7328 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7329 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7330
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007331 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007332
7333
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007334option ldap-check
7335 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 yes | no | yes | yes
7338 Arguments : none
7339
7340 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7341 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7342 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7343 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7344
7345 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7346 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7347
7348 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7349 configure it.
7350
7351 Example :
7352 option ldap-check
7353
7354 See also : "option httpchk"
7355
7356
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007357option external-check
7358 Use external processes for server health checks
7359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7360 yes | no | yes | yes
7361
7362 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7363 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7364 command".
7365
7366 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7367
7368 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7369
7370
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007371option log-health-checks
7372no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007373 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7375 yes | no | yes | yes
7376 Arguments : none
7377
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007378 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7379 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7380 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007381
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007382 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7383 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7384 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7385 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7386 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7387
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007388 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007389 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007390
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007391 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7392 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7393 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007394
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007395
7396option log-separate-errors
7397no option log-separate-errors
7398 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7400 yes | yes | yes | no
7401 Arguments : none
7402
7403 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7404 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7405 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7406 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7407 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7408 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7409 provides very important information.
7410
7411 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7412 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7413 error logs.
7414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007415 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007416 logging.
7417
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007418
7419option logasap
7420no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007421 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 yes | yes | yes | no
7424 Arguments : none
7425
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007426 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7427 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7428 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7429 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7430
7431 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7432 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7433 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7434 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7435 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7436 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7437 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7438 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7439 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7440 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7441 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007442
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007443 Examples :
7444 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7445 mode http
7446 option httplog
7447 option logasap
7448 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7449
7450 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7451 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7452 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7453 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007455 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007456 logging.
7457
7458
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007459option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007460 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7462 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007463 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007464 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7465 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007466 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007467
7468 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7469 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007470 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007471 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7472 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7473 in the MySQL table, like this :
7474
7475 USE mysql;
7476 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7477 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7478
7479 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007480 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007481 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7482 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7483 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7484 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7485 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7486 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7487 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7488
7489 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7490 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007491
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007492 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007493
7494 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7495 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7496 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7497 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007498 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7499 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007500
7501 See also: "option httpchk"
7502
7503
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007504option nolinger
7505no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007506 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7508 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007509 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007510
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007511 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007512 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7513 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7514 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7515 connections.
7516
7517 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7518 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7519 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7520 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7521 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7522 this too.
7523
7524 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7525 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7526 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7527
7528 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7529 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7530 for servers.
7531
7532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7534
7535
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007536option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7537 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7539 yes | yes | yes | yes
7540 Arguments :
7541 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7542 matching <network>
7543 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7544 header name.
7545
7546 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7547 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7548 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7549 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7550 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7551 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7552 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7553 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7554 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7555 possible that the client has already brought one.
7556
7557 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7558 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7559 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7560 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7561 header and requires different one.
7562
7563 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7564 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7565 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7566 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7567 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7568 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7569 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7570
7571 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7572 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7573 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7574 both are defined.
7575
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007576 Examples :
7577 # Original Destination address
7578 frontend www
7579 mode http
7580 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7581
7582 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7583 backend www
7584 mode http
7585 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7586
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007587 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007588
7589
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007590option persist
7591no option persist
7592 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7593 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7594 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007595 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007596
7597 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7598 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7599 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7600 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7601 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7602 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7603 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7604 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7605 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7606 redirected to another valid server.
7607
7608 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7609 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7610
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007611 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007612
7613
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007614option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7615 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7617 yes | no | yes | yes
7618 Arguments :
7619 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7620 PostgreSQL server.
7621
7622 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7623 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7624 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7625 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7626
7627 See also: "option httpchk"
7628
7629
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007630option prefer-last-server
7631no option prefer-last-server
7632 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7634 yes | no | yes | yes
7635 Arguments : none
7636
7637 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7638 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7639 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7640 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7641 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7642 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7643 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7644 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7645 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007646 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7647 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007648 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7649 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7650 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007651 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7652 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7653 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007654
7655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7657
7658 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7659
7660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007661option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007662option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007663no option redispatch
7664 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7666 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007667 Arguments :
7668 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7669 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7670 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007671 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007672 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007673 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007674 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7675 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7676 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007678
7679 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7680 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7681 be able to access the service anymore.
7682
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007683 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7684 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007685
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007686 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7687 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7688 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7689 following order:
7690
7691 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7692
7693 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7694 list, or
7695
7696 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7697
7698 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7699 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7700
7701 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7702 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7703 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7704 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7705
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007706 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007707 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7708 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007710 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7711 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7712
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007713 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007714
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007715
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007716option redis-check
7717 Use redis health checks for server testing
7718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7719 yes | no | yes | yes
7720 Arguments : none
7721
7722 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7723 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7724 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7725 find the "+PONG" response message.
7726
7727 Example :
7728 option redis-check
7729
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007730 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007731
7732
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007733option smtpchk
7734option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7735 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7737 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007738 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007739 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007740 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007741 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7742
7743 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7744 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7745 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7746
7747 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7748 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7749 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7750 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7751 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7752 dead server.
7753
7754 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7755 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007756 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007757 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7758
7759 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7760 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7761 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7762 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007763 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007764
7765 Example :
7766 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7767
7768 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007771option socket-stats
7772no option socket-stats
7773
7774 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7776 yes | yes | yes | no
7777
7778 Arguments : none
7779
7780
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007781option splice-auto
7782no option splice-auto
7783 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7785 yes | yes | yes | yes
7786 Arguments : none
7787
7788 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7789 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007790 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007791 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007792 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007793 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7794 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7795 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7796 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7797
7798 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7799 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7800 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7801 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7802 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7803 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7804 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7805 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7806 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7807 keyword.
7808
7809 Example :
7810 option splice-auto
7811
7812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7814
7815 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7816 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7817
7818
7819option splice-request
7820no option splice-request
7821 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7823 yes | yes | yes | yes
7824 Arguments : none
7825
7826 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007827 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007828 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7829 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7830 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7831 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7832
7833 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7834
7835 Example :
7836 option splice-request
7837
7838 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7839 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7840
7841 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7842 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7843
7844
7845option splice-response
7846no option splice-response
7847 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7849 yes | yes | yes | yes
7850 Arguments : none
7851
7852 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007853 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007854 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7855 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7856 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7857 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7858
7859 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7860
7861 Example :
7862 option splice-response
7863
7864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7866
7867 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7868 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7869
7870
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007871option spop-check
7872 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7874 no | no | no | yes
7875 Arguments : none
7876
7877 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7878 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7879 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7880 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7881
7882 Example :
7883 option spop-check
7884
7885 See also : "option httpchk"
7886
7887
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007888option srvtcpka
7889no option srvtcpka
7890 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 yes | no | yes | yes
7893 Arguments : none
7894
7895 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7896 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007897 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007898 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7899
7900 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7901 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7902 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7903 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7904
7905 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7906 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7907 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7908 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7909 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7910
7911 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7912
7913 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7914 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7915 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7916
7917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7919
7920 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7921
7922
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007923option ssl-hello-chk
7924 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 yes | no | yes | yes
7927 Arguments : none
7928
7929 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7930 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7931 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7932 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7933 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7934 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7935 hello message.
7936
7937 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7938 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7939 messages, which is appreciable.
7940
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007941 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7942 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7943 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007944
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007945 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7946
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007947
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007948option tcp-check
7949 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 yes | no | yes | yes
7952
7953 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7954 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7955
7956 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7957 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7958 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7959
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007960 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007961 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7962 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7963 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7964 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7965 only.
7966
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007967 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007968 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7969 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7970 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7971 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7972
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007973 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007974 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7975 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007976 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007977 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7978 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7979 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7980 the respective protocols.
7981 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007982 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007983
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007984 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7985 script.
7986
7987 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7988 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7989 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7990 The "comment" is of course optional.
7991
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01007992 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available
7993 to store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing
7994 those variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
7995
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007996
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007997 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007998 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007999 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008000 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008001
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008002 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008003 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008004 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008005
8006 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8007 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008008 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008009 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008010 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008011 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008012 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008013 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008014 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8015 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008016 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008017 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8018 tcp-check expect string +OK
8019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008020 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008021 (send many headers before analyzing)
8022 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008023 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008024 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8025 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8026 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8027 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008028 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008029
8030
8031 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
8032
8033
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008034option tcp-smart-accept
8035no option tcp-smart-accept
8036 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8038 yes | yes | yes | no
8039 Arguments : none
8040
8041 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8042 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8043 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8044 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8045 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8046 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8047
8048 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8049 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8050 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8051 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8052
8053 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8054 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8055 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008056 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008057
8058 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8059 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8060 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8061
8062 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8063 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8064 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8065
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008066 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8067
8068
8069option tcp-smart-connect
8070no option tcp-smart-connect
8071 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8073 yes | no | yes | yes
8074 Arguments : none
8075
8076 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8077 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8078 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8079 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8080 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8081
8082 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8083 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8084 complex.
8085
8086 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8087 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8088 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8089
8090 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8091 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8092
8093 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8094
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008095
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008096option tcpka
8097 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8099 yes | yes | yes | yes
8100 Arguments : none
8101
8102 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8103 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008104 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008105 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8106
8107 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8108 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8109 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8110 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8111
8112 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8113 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8114 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8115 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8116 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8117
8118 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8119
8120 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8121 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8122 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8123 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8124 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8125 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8126 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8127 backends.
8128
8129 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8130
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008131
8132option tcplog
8133 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008135 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008136 Arguments : none
8137
8138 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8139 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8140 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8141 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8142 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8143 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8144 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8145 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8146
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008147 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008149 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008150
8151
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008152option transparent
8153no option transparent
8154 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008156 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008157 Arguments : none
8158
8159 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8160 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8161 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8162 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8163 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8164 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8165 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8166 appropriate server.
8167
8168 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8169 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8170
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008171 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008172 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008173
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008174
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008175external-check command <command>
8176 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 yes | no | yes | yes
8179
8180 Arguments :
8181 <command> is the external command to run
8182
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008183 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8184
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008185 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008186
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008187 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8188 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8189 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8190 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8191 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8192 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008193
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008194 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8195
8196 Environment variables :
8197 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8198 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8199
8200 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8201
8202 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8203
8204 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8205 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8206 for a UNIX socket).
8207
8208 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8209
8210 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8211
8212 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8213
8214 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8215
8216 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8217
8218 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8219 socket).
8220
8221 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8222 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8223
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008224 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8225
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008226 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8227 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8228 failed.
8229
8230 Example :
8231 external-check command /bin/true
8232
8233 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8234
8235
8236external-check path <path>
8237 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8239 yes | no | yes | yes
8240
8241 Arguments :
8242 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8243
8244 The default path is "".
8245
8246 Example :
8247 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8248
8249 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8250 "external-check command"
8251
8252
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008253persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008254persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008255 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8257 yes | no | yes | yes
8258 Arguments :
8259 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008260 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8261 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008262
8263 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8264 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008265 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008266 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8267 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8268 forwarded to this server.
8269
8270 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8271 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8272 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008273 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008274 a single "listen" section.
8275
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008276 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8277 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8278 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8279
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008280 Example :
8281 listen tse-farm
8282 bind :3389
8283 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8284 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8285 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8286 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8287 persist rdp-cookie
8288 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008289 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008290 balance rdp-cookie
8291 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8292 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8293
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008294 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8295 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008296
8297
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008298rate-limit sessions <rate>
8299 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8301 yes | yes | yes | no
8302 Arguments :
8303 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8304 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8305
8306 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8307 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8308 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8309 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8310 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8311 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8312
8313 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8314 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8315 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8316 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8317
8318 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8319 listen smtp
8320 mode tcp
8321 bind :25
8322 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008323 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008324
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008325 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8326 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8327 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008328
8329 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8330
8331
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008332redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8333redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8334redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008335 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8337 no | yes | yes | yes
8338
8339 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008340 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008341
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008342 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008343 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008344 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8345 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8346 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008347
8348 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8349 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8350 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8351 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8352 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008353 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8354 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8355 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8356 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008357
8358 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8359 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8360 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8361 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8362 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8363 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008364 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008365 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008366 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8367 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8368 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008369
8370 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008371 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8372 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8373 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008374 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008375 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8376 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8377 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8378 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008379
8380 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008381 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008382
8383 - "drop-query"
8384 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8385 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8386 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8387 with a location-type redirect.
8388
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008389 - "append-slash"
8390 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8391 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8392 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8393 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8394
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008395 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8396 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8397 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8398 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8399 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8400 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8401 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8402
8403 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8404 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8405 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8406 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8407 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8408 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8409 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008410
8411 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8412 acl clear dst_port 80
8413 acl secure dst_port 8080
8414 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008415 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008416 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008417 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8418
8419 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008420 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8421 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8422 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008423 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008424
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008425 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8426 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8427 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8428
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008429 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008430 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008431
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008432 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008433 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8434 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8435 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008437 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008438
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008439
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008440retries <value>
8441 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8442 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8443 yes | no | yes | yes
8444 Arguments :
8445 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8446 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8447 default value is 3.
8448
8449 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8450 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8451 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8452
8453 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008454 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8455 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008456
8457 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8458 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8459
8460 See also : "option redispatch"
8461
8462
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008463retry-on [list of keywords]
8464 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8466 yes | no | yes | yes
8467 Arguments :
8468 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8469 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8470 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8471 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8472
8473 none never retry
8474
8475 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8476 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8477
8478 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8479 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8480 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8481 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8482 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8483 processing the request.
8484
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008485 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8486 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8487 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8488 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8489 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8490 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8491 overflow attack for example).
8492
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008493 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8494 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8495 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8496 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8497 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8498 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8499 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8500 amplify denial of service attacks.
8501
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008502 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8503 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8504 considered to be safe to retry.
8505
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008506 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8507 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8508 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8509 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8510
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008511 all-retryable-errors
8512 retry request for any error that are considered
8513 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8514 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8515 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8516
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008517 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8518 not cumulative.
8519
8520 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8521 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8522 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8523 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8524
8525 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8526 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8527 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8528 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8529 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8530 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8531 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8532 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8533 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8534 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8535 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8536 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8537
8538 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8539 should not use this directive.
8540
8541 The default is "conn-failure".
8542
8543 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8544
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008545server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008546 Declare a server in a backend
8547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8548 no | no | yes | yes
8549 Arguments :
8550 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008551 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008552 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008553
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008554 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8555 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8556 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8557 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008558 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8559 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8560 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8561 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8562 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008563 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8564 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8565 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8566 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8567 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8568 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8569 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008570 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008571 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8572 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8573 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8574 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8575 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8576 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008577 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8578 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008579 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8580 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008581
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008582 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008583 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8584 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8585 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8586 adding this value to the client's port.
8587
8588 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8589 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008590 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008591
8592 Examples :
8593 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8594 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008595 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008596 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8597 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8598 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008599
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008600 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8601 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8602 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8603 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8604 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8605
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008606 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8607 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008608
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008609server-state-file-name [<file>]
8610 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8611 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8612 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8613 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8614 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8615 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8616
8617 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8618 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8619
8620 global
8621 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8622
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008623 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008624 load-server-state-from-file
8625
8626 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8627 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008628
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008629server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8630 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8631 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8633 no | no | yes | yes
8634
8635 Arguments:
8636 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8637
8638 <num | range>
8639 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8640 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8641 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8642 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8643
8644 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8645
8646 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8647
8648 <params*>
8649 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8650 keyword.
8651
8652 Examples:
8653 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8654 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8655 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8656
8657 # or
8658 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8659
8660 # would be equivalent to:
8661 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8662 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8663 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8664
8665
8666
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008667source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008668source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008669source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008670 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8672 yes | no | yes | yes
8673 Arguments :
8674 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8675 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008676
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008677 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008678 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8679 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8680 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8681 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8682 supported prefixes are :
8683 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8684 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8685 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008686 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008687 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8688 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008689
8690 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8691 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008692 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8693 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8694 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008695
8696 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8697 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8698 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8699 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8700 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8701 <addr>.
8702
8703 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8704 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8705 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8706 port.
8707
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008708 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8709 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8710 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8711 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008712 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008713 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8714 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8715 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8716 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8717 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8718 HTTP header.
8719
8720 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8721 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008722 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008723 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8724 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8725 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8726 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8727 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8728 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8729 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8730
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008731 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8732 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8733 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8734 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8735 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8736 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8737
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008738 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8739 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8740 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8741 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8742
8743 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8744 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8745 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8746 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8747 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8748 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8749
8750 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8751 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8752 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8753 there are two methods :
8754
8755 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8756 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8757 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8758 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8759 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8760 of the client ranges may be used.
8761
8762 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8763 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8764 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8765 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8766 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8767 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8768 same session.
8769
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008770 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8771 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8772 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008773 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008774
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008775 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8776
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008777 Examples :
8778 backend private
8779 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8780 source 192.168.1.200
8781
8782 backend transparent_ssl1
8783 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8784 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8785
8786 backend transparent_ssl2
8787 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8788 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8789 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8790
8791 backend transparent_ssl3
8792 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8793 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8794 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8795
8796 backend transparent_smtp
8797 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8798 # with Tproxy version 4.
8799 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8800
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008801 backend transparent_http
8802 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8803 # proxy.
8804 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008806 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008807 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8808
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008809
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008810stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8811 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008813 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008814
8815 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8816 matched.
8817
8818 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8819 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8820
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008821 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8822 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008823 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008824
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008825 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8826 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8827 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8828 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008829
8830 Example :
8831 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8832 backend stats_localhost
8833 stats enable
8834 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8835
8836 Example :
8837 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8838 backend stats_auth
8839 stats enable
8840 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8841 stats admin if TRUE
8842
8843 Example :
8844 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8845 userlist stats-auth
8846 group admin users admin
8847 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8848 group readonly users haproxy
8849 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8850
8851 backend stats_auth
8852 stats enable
8853 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8854 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8855 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8856 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8857
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008858 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8859 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8860 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008861
8862
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008863stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8864 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008866 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008867 Arguments :
8868 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8869
8870 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8871
8872 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8873 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8874 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8875 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8876 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8877 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8878
8879 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8880 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8881 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008882 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008883
8884 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8885 report using "stats scope".
8886
8887 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8888 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8889 unobvious parameters.
8890
8891 Example :
8892 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8893 backend public_www
8894 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8895 stats enable
8896 stats hide-version
8897 stats scope .
8898 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008899 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008900 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8901 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8902
8903 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8904 backend private_monitoring
8905 stats enable
8906 stats uri /admin?stats
8907 stats refresh 5s
8908
8909 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8910
8911
8912stats enable
8913 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008915 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008916 Arguments : none
8917
8918 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8919 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8920 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8921 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8922 - stats auth : no authentication
8923 - stats scope : no restriction
8924
8925 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8926 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8927 unobvious parameters.
8928
8929 Example :
8930 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8931 backend public_www
8932 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8933 stats enable
8934 stats hide-version
8935 stats scope .
8936 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008937 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008938 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8939 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8940
8941 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8942 backend private_monitoring
8943 stats enable
8944 stats uri /admin?stats
8945 stats refresh 5s
8946
8947 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8948
8949
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008950stats hide-version
8951 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008953 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008954 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008955
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008956 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8957 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8958 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8959 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8960 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8961 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008963 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8964 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8965 unobvious parameters.
8966
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008967 Example :
8968 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8969 backend public_www
8970 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008971 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008972 stats hide-version
8973 stats scope .
8974 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008975 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008976 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8977 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008978
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008979 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8980 backend private_monitoring
8981 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008982 stats uri /admin?stats
8983 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008984
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008985 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008986
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008987
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008988stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8989 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8990 Access control for statistics
8991
8992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8993 no | no | yes | yes
8994
8995 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8996 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8997 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8998 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8999 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9000 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9001
9002 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9003 instance.
9004
9005 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9006 about ACL usage.
9007
9008
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009009stats realm <realm>
9010 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009012 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009013 Arguments :
9014 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9015 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9016 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9017
9018 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9019 using a backslash ('\').
9020
9021 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9022 only related to authentication.
9023
9024 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9025 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9026 unobvious parameters.
9027
9028 Example :
9029 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9030 backend public_www
9031 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9032 stats enable
9033 stats hide-version
9034 stats scope .
9035 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009036 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009037 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9038 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9039
9040 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9041 backend private_monitoring
9042 stats enable
9043 stats uri /admin?stats
9044 stats refresh 5s
9045
9046 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9047
9048
9049stats refresh <delay>
9050 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009052 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009053 Arguments :
9054 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9055 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9056 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9057 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9058 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9059 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9060
9061 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9062 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9063 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9064 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9065
9066 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9067 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9068 unobvious parameters.
9069
9070 Example :
9071 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9072 backend public_www
9073 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9074 stats enable
9075 stats hide-version
9076 stats scope .
9077 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009078 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009079 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9080 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9081
9082 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9083 backend private_monitoring
9084 stats enable
9085 stats uri /admin?stats
9086 stats refresh 5s
9087
9088 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9089
9090
9091stats scope { <name> | "." }
9092 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009094 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009095 Arguments :
9096 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9097 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9098 section in which the statement appears.
9099
9100 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9101 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9102 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9103 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9104 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9105 exists.
9106
9107 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9108 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9109 unobvious parameters.
9110
9111 Example :
9112 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9113 backend public_www
9114 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9115 stats enable
9116 stats hide-version
9117 stats scope .
9118 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009119 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009120 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9121 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9122
9123 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9124 backend private_monitoring
9125 stats enable
9126 stats uri /admin?stats
9127 stats refresh 5s
9128
9129 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009131
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009132stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009133 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009135 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009136
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009137 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009138 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9139
9140 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9141 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9142
9143 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9144 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009145 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009146
9147 Example :
9148 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9149 backend private_monitoring
9150 stats enable
9151 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9152 stats uri /admin?stats
9153 stats refresh 5s
9154
9155 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9156 global section.
9157
9158
9159stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009160 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9162 yes | yes | yes | yes
9163 Arguments : none
9164
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009165 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009166 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9167 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9168 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9169 - IP (socket, server)
9170 - cookie (backend, server)
9171
9172 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9173 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009174 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009175
9176 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9177
9178
9179stats show-node [ <name> ]
9180 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009182 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009183 Arguments:
9184 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9185 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9186
9187 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9188 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009189 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009190
9191 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9192 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9193 unobvious parameters.
9194
9195 Example:
9196 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9197 backend private_monitoring
9198 stats enable
9199 stats show-node Europe-1
9200 stats uri /admin?stats
9201 stats refresh 5s
9202
9203 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9204 section.
9205
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009206
9207stats uri <prefix>
9208 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009210 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009211 Arguments :
9212 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9213 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9214 query string.
9215
9216 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9217 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9218 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9219 possible to reach it in the application.
9220
9221 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009222 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009223 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9224 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9225 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9226 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9227
9228 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9229 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9230 an address or a port to statistics only.
9231
9232 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9233 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9234 unobvious parameters.
9235
9236 Example :
9237 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9238 backend public_www
9239 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9240 stats enable
9241 stats hide-version
9242 stats scope .
9243 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009244 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009245 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9246 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9247
9248 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9249 backend private_monitoring
9250 stats enable
9251 stats uri /admin?stats
9252 stats refresh 5s
9253
9254 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9255
9256
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009257stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9258 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009260 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009261
9262 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009263 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009264 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009265 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009266 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9267
9268 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9269 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9270 the "stick-table" statement.
9271
9272 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9273 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9274 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9275 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9276 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9277
9278 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9279 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9280 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9281 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9282 transformation rules.
9283
9284 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9285 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9286 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9287 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9288 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9289 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9290 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9291
9292 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9293 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9294 ACL based conditions.
9295
9296 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9297 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9298 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9299 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9300
9301 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9302 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9303 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9304 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9305
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009306 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9307 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009308 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009309
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009310 Example :
9311 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9312 # last 30 minutes
9313 backend pop
9314 mode tcp
9315 balance roundrobin
9316 stick store-request src
9317 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9318 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9319 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9320
9321 backend smtp
9322 mode tcp
9323 balance roundrobin
9324 stick match src table pop
9325 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9326 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9327
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009328 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009329 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009330
9331
9332stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9333 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9335 no | no | yes | yes
9336
9337 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9338 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9339 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9340 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9341
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009342 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9343 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009344 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009345
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009346 Examples :
9347 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009348 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009349
9350 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9351 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9352 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9353
9354
9355 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9356 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9357 backend http
9358 mode http
9359 balance roundrobin
9360 stick on src table https
9361 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9362 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9363 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9364
9365 backend https
9366 mode tcp
9367 balance roundrobin
9368 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9369 stick on src
9370 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9371 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9372
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009373 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009374
9375
9376stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9377 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9379 no | no | yes | yes
9380
9381 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009382 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009383 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009384 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009385 server is selected.
9386
9387 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9388 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9389 the "stick-table" statement.
9390
9391 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9392 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9393 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9394 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9395 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9396 address.
9397
9398 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9399 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9400 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9401 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9402 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9403 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9404 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9405 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9406 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9407 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9408
9409 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9410 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9411 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9412 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9413 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9414 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9415 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9416
9417 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9418 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9419 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9420 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9421
9422 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9423 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9424 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9425 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9426 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9427 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009428 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9429 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9430 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9431 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9432 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9433 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009434
9435 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9436 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9437 the request.
9438
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009439 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9440 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009441 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009442
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009443 Example :
9444 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9445 # last 30 minutes
9446 backend pop
9447 mode tcp
9448 balance roundrobin
9449 stick store-request src
9450 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9451 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9452 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9453
9454 backend smtp
9455 mode tcp
9456 balance roundrobin
9457 stick match src table pop
9458 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9459 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9460
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009461 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009462 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009463
9464
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009465stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009466 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9467 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009468 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009470 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009471
9472 Arguments :
9473 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9474 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9475 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9476 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9477
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009478 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9479 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9480 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9481 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9482
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009483 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9484 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9485 instance.
9486
9487 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9488 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9489 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9490 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9491 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9492 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009493 to 32 characters.
9494
9495 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9496 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9497 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009498 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009499 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9500 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009501
9502 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009503 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9504 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009505 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9506 increase.
9507
9508 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009509 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9510 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9511 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009512
9513 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9514 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9515 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9516 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009517 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009518 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9519 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9520 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9521 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9522 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9523 parameter (see below).
9524
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009525 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9526 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9527 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9528 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9529 soft restart.
9530
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009531 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9532 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009533
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009534 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9535 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9536 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9537 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009538 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009539 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009540 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9541 if not expiration delay is specified.
9542
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009543 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9544 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9545 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9546 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009547 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9548 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9549 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9550 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9551 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9552 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9553 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9554 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9555 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9556 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9557 types and their arguments.
9558
9559 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9560 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9561 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9562 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9563
9564 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9565 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9566 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009567 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009568
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009569 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9570 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9571 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009572 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009573 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009574 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009575
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009576 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9577 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9578 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9579 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9580
9581 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9582 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9583 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9584 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9585 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9586 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9587
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009588 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9589 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9590 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9591 they were received.
9592
9593 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9594 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9595 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9596 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9597 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9598
9599 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9600 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9601 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9602 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9603 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9604
9605 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9606 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9607 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9608
9609 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9610 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9611 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9612 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9613 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9614
9615 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9616 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9617 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9618 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9619 the client side.
9620
9621 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9622 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9623 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9624 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9625 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9626 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9627 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9628
9629 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9630 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9631 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9632 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9633 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9634 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009635 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009636
9637 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9638 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9639 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9640 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9641 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9642 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9643
9644 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009645 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009646 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9647 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9648
9649 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9650 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9651 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9652 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9653 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9654 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9655 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9656 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9657 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9658 recommended for better fairness.
9659
9660 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009661 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009662 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9663 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9664
9665 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9666 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9667 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9668 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9669 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9670 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9671 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9672 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9673 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9674 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009675
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009676 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9677 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009678 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9679 reference it.
9680
9681 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9682 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009683 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9684 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9685 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009686
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009687 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9688 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9689 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9690 something that can be ignored.
9691
9692 Example:
9693 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9694 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9695 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9696 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9697
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009698 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009699 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009700
9701
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009702stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009703 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9705 no | no | yes | yes
9706
9707 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009708 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009709 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009710 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009711 server is selected.
9712
9713 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9714 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9715 the "stick-table" statement.
9716
9717 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9718 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9719 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9720 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9721
9722 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9723 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9724 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9725 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9726 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9727 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009728 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009729 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9730 rules.
9731
9732 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9733 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9734 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9735 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9736 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9737 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9738 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9739
9740 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9741 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9742 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9743 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9744
9745 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9746 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9747 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9748 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9749 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9750 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009751 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9752 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9753 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9754 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9755 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9756 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9757 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9758 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9759 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009760
9761 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9762
9763 Example :
9764 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9765 backend https
9766 mode tcp
9767 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009768 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009769 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009770
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009771 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9772 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9773
9774 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9775 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9776 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9777
9778 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9779 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009780
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009781 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9782 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9783 # at offset 44.
9784
9785 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9786 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9787
9788 # Learn on response if server hello.
9789 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009790
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009791 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9792 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9793
9794 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9795 extraction.
9796
9797
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009798tcp-check connect [params*]
9799 Opens a new connection
9800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02009801 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009802
9803 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9804 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9805 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9806
9807 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9808 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9809 of the sequence.
9810
9811 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9812 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9813 do.
9814
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009815 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
9816 unset-var or comment rules.
9817
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009818 Parameters :
9819 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9820 use the TCP connection.
9821
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +02009822 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +02009823 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +02009824
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +02009825 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +02009826 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9827 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +02009828 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +02009829
9830 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009831
9832 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9833
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +02009834 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
9835
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009836 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9837
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +02009838 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
9839
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +02009840 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
9841 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
9842 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9843 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
9844
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +02009845 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009846
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009847 Examples:
9848 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9849 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9850 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9851 option tcp-check
9852 tcp-check connect
9853 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9854 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9855 tcp-check send \r\n
9856 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9857 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9858 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9859 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9860 tcp-check send \r\n
9861 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9862 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9863
9864 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9865 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009866 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009867 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9868 tcp-check connect port 143
9869 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9870 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9871
9872 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9873
9874
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +02009875tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>]
9876 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +02009877 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +02009878 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009879 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02009881 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009882
9883 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009884 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
9885 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
9886 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
9887 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
9888 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
9889 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
9890 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
9891 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
9892 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
9893 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
9894
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009895 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009896 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
9897 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009898 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9899 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9900 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9901
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +02009902 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
9903 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
9904 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
9905 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported and may be used to set,
9906 respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7OK, HCHK_STATUS_L7OKCD,
9907 HCHK_STATUS_L6OK or HCHK_STATUS_L4OK success status.
9908 By default "L7OK" is used.
9909
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +02009910 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
9911 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
9912 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported and
9913 may be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7RSP,
9914 HCHK_STATUS_L7STS, HCHK_STATUS_L6RSP or HCHK_STATUS_L4CON
9915 error status. By default "L7RSP" is used.
9916
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +02009917 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +02009918 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
9919 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported and may
9920 be used to set, respectively, HCHK_STATUS_L7TOUT,
9921 HCHK_STATUS_L6TOUT or HCHK_STATUS_L4TOUT timeout status.
9922 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
9923
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +02009924 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
9925 informational message reported in logs if the expect
9926 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
9927 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
9928
9929 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
9930 informational message reported in logs if an error
9931 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
9932 log-format string.
9933
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +02009934 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
9935 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
9936 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9937 followed by some converters.
9938
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009939 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9940 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9941 with the usual backslash ('\').
9942 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009943 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009944 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9945 used upper or lower case.
9946
9947
9948 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9949
9950 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9951 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9952 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9953 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9954 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9955 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9956 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9957 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9958
9959 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9960 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9961 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9962 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9963 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9964 expression.
9965
9966 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9967 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9968 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9969 this exact hexadecimal string.
9970 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9971
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009972 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
9973 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
9974 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
9975 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
9976 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
9977 size of the original response. As such, the expected
9978 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
9979 size.
9980
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009981 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9982 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9983 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9984 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9985 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9986 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9987 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9988 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9989 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9990 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9991 the null character.
9992
9993 Examples :
9994 # perform a POP check
9995 option tcp-check
9996 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9997
9998 # perform an IMAP check
9999 option tcp-check
10000 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10001
10002 # look for the redis master server
10003 option tcp-check
10004 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010005 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010006 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10007 tcp-check expect string role:master
10008 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10009 tcp-check expect string +OK
10010
10011
10012 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10013 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10014
10015
10016tcp-check send <data>
10017 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010019 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010020
10021 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10022 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
10023
10024 Examples :
10025 # look for the redis master server
10026 option tcp-check
10027 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10028 tcp-check expect string role:master
10029
10030 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10031 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10032
10033
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010034tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10035 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010036 tcp health check
10037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010038 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010039
10040 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10041 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010042 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010043 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10044 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10045 hexadecimal string.
10046 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10047
10048 Examples :
10049 # redis check in binary
10050 option tcp-check
10051 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10052 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10053
10054
10055 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10056 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10057
10058
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010059tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10060
10061 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
10062
10063 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010064 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010065
10066 Arguments:
10067 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10068 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10069 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10070 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10071 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10072 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10073 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10074 and '-'.
10075
10076 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10077
10078 Example:
10079 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10080
10081
10082tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
10083
10084 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
10085
10086 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010087 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010088
10089 Arguments:
10090 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10091 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10092 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10093 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10094 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10095 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10096 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10097 and '-'.
10098
10099 Example:
10100 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10101
10102
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010103tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10104 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10106 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010107 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010108 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10109 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010111 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010112
10113 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10114 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010115 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10116 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10117 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10118 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10119 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10120 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010121
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010122 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10123 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10124 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10125 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010126
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010127 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010128 - accept :
10129 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10130 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10131 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010132
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010133 - reject :
10134 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10135 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10136 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10137 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10138 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10139 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10140 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10141 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10142 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10143 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10144 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010145 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010146
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010147 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10148 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10149 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10150 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10151 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10152 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10153 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10154 hosts.
10155
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010156 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10157 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10158 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10159 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10160 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10161 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10162 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10163 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10164
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010165 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10166 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10167 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10168 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10169 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10170 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10171 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10172 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10173 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010174 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10175 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010176
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010177 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010178 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010179 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10180 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10181 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010182 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010183 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10184 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10185 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10186 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10187 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10188 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10189 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10190 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010191
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010192 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010193 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010194 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010195 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010196 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10197 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10198 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010199
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010200 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10201 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10202 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10203 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010205 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10206 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10207 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10208 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10209 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010210 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10211 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10212 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10213 layer7 information is extracted.
10214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010215 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10216 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10217 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10218 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10219 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010220
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010221 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10222 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10223 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10224 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10225
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010226 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10227 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10228 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10229 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10230
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010231 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10232 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10233 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10234 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10235 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010236
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010237 - set-src <expr> :
10238 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10239 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10240 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010241 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010242
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010243 Arguments:
10244 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10245 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010246
10247 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010248 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10249
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010250 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10251 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010252
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010253 - set-src-port <expr> :
10254 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10255 expression.
10256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010257 Arguments:
10258 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10259 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010260
10261 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010262 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10263
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010264 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10265 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10266 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010267
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010268 - set-dst <expr> :
10269 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10270 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10271 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10272 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10273 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10274
10275 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10276 followed by some converters.
10277
10278 Example:
10279
10280 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10281 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10282
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010283 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10284 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10285
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010286 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10287 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10288 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10289 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10290
10291
10292 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10293 followed by some converters.
10294
10295 Example:
10296
10297 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10298
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010299 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10300 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10301 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10302
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010303 - "silent-drop" :
10304 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010305 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010306 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10307 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10308 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10309 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10310 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010311 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10312 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010313 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10314 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010315 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010316 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10317 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10318 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10319 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010321 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10322 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10323 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010325 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10326 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10327 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010329 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010330 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010331 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010332
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010333 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10334 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10335 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010336
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010337 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010338 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10339 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010340
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010341 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10342
10343 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10344
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010345 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10346
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010347 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010348
10349
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010350tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10351 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010353 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010354 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010355 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10356 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010357
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010358 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010360 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010361 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10362 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10363 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10364 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010365
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010366 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10367 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10368 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10369 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010370 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10371 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10372 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10373 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10374 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10375 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010376 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010377 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010378
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010379 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10380 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10381 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10382 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010383
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010384 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010385 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010386 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010387 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10388 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010389 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010390 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010391 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010392 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010393 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010394 - set-dst <expr>
10395 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010396 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010397 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010398 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010399 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010400 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010401
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010402 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10403 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010404 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10405 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010406
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010407 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10408 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10409 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10410 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10411 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10412 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010414 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010415 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10416 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010418 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010419 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10420 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10421 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10422 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010423 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10424 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10425 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010426
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010427 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010428 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10429 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10430 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010431
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010432 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10433 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10434
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010435 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010436 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10437 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010438
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010439 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10440 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010441 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010442 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10443 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010444 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010445 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010446 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010447 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10448 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010449 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010450 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10451 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010452
10453 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10454 followed by some converters.
10455
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010456 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10457 <var-name>.
10458
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010459 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10460 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10461 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10462 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10463 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10464
10465 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10466 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10467 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10468 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10469 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10470 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10471 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10472 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10473 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10474 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10475 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10476
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010477 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10478 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10479 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10480 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10481 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10482
10483 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10484
10485 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10486
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010487 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10488 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10489 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10490 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10491 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10492 evaluated.
10493
10494 Example:
10495 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10496
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010497 Example:
10498
10499 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010500 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010501
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010502 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010503 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10504 # and reject everything else.
10505 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10506 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010507 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010508 tcp-request content reject
10509
10510 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010511 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10512 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10513 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010514 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010515
10516 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10517 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10518 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010519 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010520 tcp-request content reject
10521
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010522 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010523 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010524 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010525 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010526 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10527 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010528
10529 Example:
10530 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10531 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010532 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010534 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010535 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010536
10537 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010538 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010539 # protecting all our sites
10540 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010541 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10542 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010543 ...
10544 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10545
10546 backend http_dynamic
10547 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010548 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010549 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010550 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010551 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010552 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010553 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010555 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010556
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010557 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10558 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010559
10560
10561tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10562 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010564 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010565 Arguments :
10566 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10567 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10568 as explained at the top of this document.
10569
10570 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10571 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10572 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10573 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10574 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10575
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010576 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10577 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10578 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10579 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10580
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010581 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10582 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010583 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010584 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010585 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10586 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10587 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10588 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010589
10590 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10591 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10592 it pass through unaffected.
10593
10594 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10595 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10596 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010597 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010598 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10599 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010600 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10601 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10602 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010603
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010604 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010605 "timeout client".
10606
10607
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010608tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10609 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10611 no | no | yes | yes
10612 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010613 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10614 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010615
10616 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10617
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010618 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010619 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10620 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010621 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10622 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010623
10624 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10625
10626 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10627 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10628 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10629 inserted.
10630
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010631 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010632 - accept :
10633 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10634 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10635 the rules evaluation.
10636
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010637 - close :
10638 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10639 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10640 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10641 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10642 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10643 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010644 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010645 protocols.
10646
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010647 - reject :
10648 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10649 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010650 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010651
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010652 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10653 Sets a variable.
10654
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010655 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10656 Unsets a variable.
10657
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010658 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10659 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10660 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10661 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10662
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010663 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10664 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10665 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10666 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10667
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010668 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10669 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10670 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10671 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10672 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010673
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010674 - "silent-drop" :
10675 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010676 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010677 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10678 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10679 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10680 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10681 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010682 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10683 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010684 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10685 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010686 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010687 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10688 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10689 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10690 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10691
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010692 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10693 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10694
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010695 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10696 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10697 for changing the default action to a reject.
10698
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010699 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10700 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10701 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10702 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010703 period.
10704
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010705 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10706 declared inline.
10707
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010708 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10709 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010710 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010711 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10712 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010713 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010714 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010715 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010716 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10717 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010718 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010719 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10720 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010721
10722 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10723 followed by some converters.
10724
10725 Example:
10726
10727 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10728
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010729 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10730 <var-name>.
10731
10732 Example:
10733
10734 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10735
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010736 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10737 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10738 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10739 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10740 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10741
10742 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10743
10744 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10745
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010746 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10747
10748 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10749
10750
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010751tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10752 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10754 no | yes | yes | no
10755 Arguments :
10756 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10757 below.
10758
10759 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10760
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010761 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010762 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10763 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10764 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10765 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10766 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10767 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10768 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010769 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010770 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10771 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10772 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10773 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10774 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10775 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10776 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10777 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10778 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10779 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10780 instead.
10781
10782 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10783 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10784 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10785 rules which may be inserted.
10786
10787 Several types of actions are supported :
10788 - accept : the request is accepted
10789 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10790 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10791 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010792 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010793 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010794 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010795 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010796 - silent-drop
10797
10798 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10799 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10800 sections for a complete description.
10801
10802 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10803 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10804 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10805
10806 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10807 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10808 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10809 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10810 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10811
10812 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10813 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10814
10815 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10816 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10817 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10818
10819 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10820 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10821 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10822
10823 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10824 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10825 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10826
10827 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10828 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10829 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10830
10831 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10832
10833 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10834
10835
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010836tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10837 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10839 no | no | yes | yes
10840 Arguments :
10841 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10843 as explained at the top of this document.
10844
10845 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10846
10847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010848timeout check <timeout>
10849 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10850 established.
10851
10852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10853 yes | no | yes | yes
10854 Arguments:
10855 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10856 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10857 as explained at the top of this document.
10858
10859 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10860 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010861 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010862 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010863 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10864 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10865 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010866
10867 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10868 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10869
10870 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10871 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010872 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010873
10874 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10875 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10876 forget about it.
10877
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010878 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10879 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010880
10881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010882timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010883 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10885 yes | yes | yes | no
10886 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010887 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010888 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10889 as explained at the top of this document.
10890
10891 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10892 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10893 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010894 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10895 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10896 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10897 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010898 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10899 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10900 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010901 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010902 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010903 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10904 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010905 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10906 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010907
10908 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10909 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10910 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10911 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010912 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010913 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10914
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010915 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010916
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010917 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010918
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010919
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010920timeout client-fin <timeout>
10921 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10923 yes | yes | yes | no
10924 Arguments :
10925 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10926 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10927 as explained at the top of this document.
10928
10929 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10930 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10931 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10932 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10933 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10934 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10935 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010936 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10937 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10938 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010939
10940 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10941 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10942 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10943
10944 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10945
10946
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010947timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010948 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10950 yes | no | yes | yes
10951 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010952 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010953 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10954 as explained at the top of this document.
10955
10956 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010957 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010958 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010959 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010960 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10961 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010962
10963 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10964 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10965 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10966 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010967 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010968 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10969
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010970 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010972
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010973timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10974 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10976 yes | yes | yes | yes
10977 Arguments :
10978 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10979 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10980 as explained at the top of this document.
10981
10982 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10983 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10984 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10985 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10986 once the request has started to present itself.
10987
10988 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10989 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10990 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10991 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10992 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10993
10994 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10995 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10996 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10997 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10998
10999 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11000 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011001 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011002 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11003 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011004 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011005
11006 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11007 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11008 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11009 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11010
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011011 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11012 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011013 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11014
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011015 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11016
11017
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011018timeout http-request <timeout>
11019 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011021 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011022 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011023 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011024 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11025 as explained at the top of this document.
11026
11027 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11028 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11029 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11030 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11031 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11032 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11033 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011034 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11035 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11036 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11037 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011038 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011039 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11040 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011041
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011042 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11043 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11044 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11045 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11046 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011047 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011048
11049 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11050 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011051 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011052 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11053 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11054
11055 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011056 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11057 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11058 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011059
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011060 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011061 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011062
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011063
11064timeout queue <timeout>
11065 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11067 yes | no | yes | yes
11068 Arguments :
11069 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11070 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11071 as explained at the top of this document.
11072
11073 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11074 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11075 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11076 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11077 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11078
11079 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11080 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11081 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11082 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11083
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011084 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011085
11086
11087timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011088 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11090 yes | no | yes | yes
11091 Arguments :
11092 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11093 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11094 as explained at the top of this document.
11095
11096 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11097 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11098 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11099 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11100 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11101 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11102 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11103
11104 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11105 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11106 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11107 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11108 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011109 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011110 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011111 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11112 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011113 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11114 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011115
11116 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11117 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11118 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11119 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011120 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011121 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11122
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011123 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011124
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011125
11126timeout server-fin <timeout>
11127 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11129 yes | no | yes | yes
11130 Arguments :
11131 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11132 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11133 as explained at the top of this document.
11134
11135 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11136 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11137 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11138 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11139 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11140 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11141 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11142 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11143 situations, it should not be needed.
11144
11145 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11146 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11147 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11148
11149 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11150
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011151
11152timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011153 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11155 yes | yes | yes | yes
11156 Arguments :
11157 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11158 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11159 as explained at the top of this document.
11160
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011161 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11162 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11163 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011164
11165 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11166 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11167 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11168 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011169 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011170
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011171 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011172
11173
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011174timeout tunnel <timeout>
11175 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11177 yes | no | yes | yes
11178 Arguments :
11179 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11180 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11181 as explained at the top of this document.
11182
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011183 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011184 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11185 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11186 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011187 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11188 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011189 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11190 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11191 specified.
11192
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011193 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11194 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11195 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11196 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11197 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11198 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11199 state.
11200
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011201 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11202 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11203 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11204 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011205 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011206
11207 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11208 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11209 forget about it.
11210
11211 Example :
11212 defaults http
11213 option http-server-close
11214 timeout connect 5s
11215 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011216 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011217 timeout server 30s
11218 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11219
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011220 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011221
11222
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011223transparent (deprecated)
11224 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011226 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011227 Arguments : none
11228
11229 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11230 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11231 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11232 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11233 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11234 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11235 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11236 appropriate server.
11237
11238 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11239
11240 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11241 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11242
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011243 See also: "option transparent"
11244
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011245unique-id-format <string>
11246 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11248 yes | yes | yes | no
11249 Arguments :
11250 <string> is a log-format string.
11251
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011252 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11253 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11254 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11255 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011256
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011257 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11258 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11259 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11260 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11261 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11262 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11263 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11264 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011265
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011266 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11267 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011268
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011269 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011270
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011271 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011272
11273 will generate:
11274
11275 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11276
11277 See also: "unique-id-header"
11278
11279unique-id-header <name>
11280 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11282 yes | yes | yes | no
11283 Arguments :
11284 <name> is the name of the header.
11285
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011286 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11287 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011288
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011289 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011290
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011291 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011292 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11293
11294 will generate:
11295
11296 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11297
11298 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011299
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011300use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011301 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11303 no | yes | yes | no
11304 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011305 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11306 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011307
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011308 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11309 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011310
11311 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11312 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11313 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011314 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011315 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011316 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11317 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011318
11319 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11320 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11321 assign the backend.
11322
11323 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11324 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11325 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11326 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11327 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11328 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11329
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011330 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011331 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011332 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11333 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11334 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11335
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011336 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11337 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11338 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11339 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11340 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11341 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11342 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11343 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11344 cannot be forced from the request.
11345
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011346 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011347 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11348 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11349
11350 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11351 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011352
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011353use-fcgi-app <name>
11354 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11356 no | no | yes | yes
11357 Arguments :
11358 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11359
11360 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011361
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011362use-server <server> if <condition>
11363use-server <server> unless <condition>
11364 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11366 no | no | yes | yes
11367 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011368 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11369 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011370
11371 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11372
11373 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11374 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11375 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11376
11377 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11378 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11379 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11380 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11381 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11382 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11383 matches will assign the server.
11384
11385 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11386 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11387 with the next rules until one matches.
11388
11389 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11390 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11391 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11392 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11393
11394 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11395 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11396 stripped.
11397
11398 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11399 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11400 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11401 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11402
11403 Example :
11404 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11405 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11406 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11407 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11408 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11409 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011410 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011411 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11412 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11413
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011414 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11415 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11416 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11417 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11418 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11419 and we fall back to load balancing.
11420
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011421 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011422
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011423
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100114245. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011425--------------------------
11426
11427The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11428depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11429settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11430written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11431described in this section.
11432
11433
114345.1. Bind options
11435-----------------
11436
11437The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11438as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11439no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11440parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11441while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11442provided immediately after the setting name.
11443
11444The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11445
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011446accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11447 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11448 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11449 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11450 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11451 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11452 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11453 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11454 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11455 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011456 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11457 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11458 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011459
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011460accept-proxy
11461 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011462 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11463 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011464 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11465 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11466 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11467 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011468 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011469 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11470 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011471 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11472 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011473
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011474allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011475 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011476 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011477 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011478 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11479 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011480
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011481alpn <protocols>
11482 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11483 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11484 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011485 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011486 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011487 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11488 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11489 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11490 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11491 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11492 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11493 preference, like below :
11494
11495 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011496
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011497backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011498 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011499 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11500
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011501curves <curves>
11502 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11503 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11504 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11505 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11506 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11507 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11508
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011509ecdhe <named curve>
11510 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011511 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11512 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011513
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011514ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11516 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11517 client's certificate.
11518
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011519ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11521 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11522 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11523 error is ignored.
11524
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011525ca-sign-file <cafile>
11526 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11527 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11528 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11529 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11530 'generate-certificates' for details.
11531
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011532ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11534 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11535 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11536 'generate-certificates' for details.
11537
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011538ca-verify-file <cafile>
11539 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11540 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11541 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11542 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11543 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11544
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011545ciphers <ciphers>
11546 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11547 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011548 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011549 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011550 information and recommendations see e.g.
11551 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11552 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11553 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11554
11555ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11557 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11558 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11559 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011560 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11561 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011562
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011563crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011564 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11565 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11566 to verify client's certificate.
11567
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011568crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11570 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11571 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11572 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11573 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011574 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11575 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011576
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011577 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11578 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11579
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011580 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11581 are loaded.
11582
11583 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011584 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11585 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11586 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11587 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11588 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11589 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11590 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011591 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011592
11593 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11594 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11595 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11596 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011597 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11598 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011599
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011600 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011602 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011603 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011604 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11605 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011606 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11607 clients).
11608
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011609 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11610 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11611 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11612 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11613 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11614 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11615 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11616 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11617 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11618 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11619 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11620 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11621 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11622
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011623 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11624 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11625 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11626 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11627 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11628
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011629 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11630 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11631 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11632 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011633
11634 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11635 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11636 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11637 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11638 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11639 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11640 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11641 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11642 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11643
11644 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11645
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011646 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011647 a cert bundle.
11648
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011649 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011650 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11651 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11652 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11653 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11654 provide multi-cert support.
11655
11656 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11657
11658 Filename | CN | SAN
11659 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11660 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011661 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011662 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11663 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11664
11665 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11666 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11667 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11668 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011669 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11670 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11671 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011672
11673 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11674 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11675
11676 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11677 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11678 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11679
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011680crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011681 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011682 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011683 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011684 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011685
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011686crt-list <file>
11687 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011688 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11689 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011690
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011691 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11692
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011693 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11694 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11695 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11696 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011697
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011698 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11699 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11700 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11701 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11702 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11703 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11704 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11705 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011706
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011707 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011708 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011709 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11710 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11711 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011712
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011713 crt-list file example:
11714 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011715 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011716 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011717 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011718
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011719defer-accept
11720 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11721 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11722 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011723 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011724 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11725 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11726 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11727 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11728 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11729 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11730 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11731
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011732expose-fd listeners
11733 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11734 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011735 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11736 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011737 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011738
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011739force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011740 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011741 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011742 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011743 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011744
11745force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011746 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011747 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011748 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011749
11750force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011751 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011752 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011753 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011754
11755force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011756 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011757 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011758 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011759
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011760force-tlsv13
11761 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11762 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011763 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011764
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011765generate-certificates
11766 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11767 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11768 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11769 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11770 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11771 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11772 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11773 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11774 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11775 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11776 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11777
11778 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11779 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011780 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011781 certificate is used many times.
11782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011783gid <gid>
11784 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11785 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11786 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11787 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11788 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11789
11790group <group>
11791 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11792 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11793 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11794 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11795 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11796
11797id <id>
11798 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11799 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11800 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11801 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11802
11803interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011804 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11805 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11806 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11807 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11808 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11809 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011810 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11811 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11812 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11813 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11814 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11815 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011816
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011817level <level>
11818 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11819 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11820 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011821 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011822 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11823 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11824 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011825 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011826 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011827 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011828 all counters).
11829
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011830severity-output <format>
11831 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11832 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11833 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11834 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11835 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11836 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11837 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11838 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11839 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11840 rfc5424 convention.
11841
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011842maxconn <maxconn>
11843 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11844 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11845 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11846 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11847 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11848 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11849 eat all memory.
11850
11851mode <mode>
11852 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11853 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11854 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11855 UNIX sockets.
11856
11857mss <maxseg>
11858 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11859 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11860 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11861 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11862 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11863 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11864 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11865 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11866 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11867 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11868 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11869
11870name <name>
11871 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11872 page.
11873
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011874namespace <name>
11875 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11876 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11877 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11878 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11879
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011880nice <nice>
11881 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11882 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11883 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11884 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11885 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11886 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11887 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11888 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11889 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11890 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11891 one for an RDP socket.
11892
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011893no-ca-names
11894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11895 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011896 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011897
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011898no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011899 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011900 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011901 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011902 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011903 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11904 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011905
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011906no-tls-tickets
11907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11908 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11909 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011910 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11911 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011912 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11913 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11914 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011915
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011916no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011918 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011919 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011920 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011921 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11922 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011923
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011924no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011926 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011927 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011928 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011929 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11930 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011931
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011932no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011934 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011935 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011936 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011937 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11938 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011939
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011940no-tlsv13
11941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11942 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11943 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11944 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011945 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11946 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011947
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011948npn <protocols>
11949 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11950 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11951 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011952 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011953 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011954 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11955 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11956 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11957 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11958 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011959
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011960prefer-client-ciphers
11961 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11962 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11963 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011964 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11965 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11966 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011967
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011968process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011969 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011970 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011971 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011972 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11973 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11974 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11975 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011976 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011977 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11978 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11979 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11980 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11981 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011982
11983 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11984
11985 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11986 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11987 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11988 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11989 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11990 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11991 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11992 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011993
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011994proto <name>
11995 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11996 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11997 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11998 in haproxy -vv.
11999 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12000 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012001 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012002 h2" on the bind line.
12003
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012004ssl
12005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012006 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012007 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12008 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012009 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12010 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012011
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012012ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12013 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
12014 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12015 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12016
12017ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12018 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
12019 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
12020 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12021
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012022strict-sni
12023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12024 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12025 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12026 See the "crt" option for more information.
12027
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012028tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012029 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012030 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12031 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012032 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012033 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12034 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12035 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12036 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12037 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12038 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12039 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12040
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012041tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012042 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012043 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12044 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12045 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12046 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12047 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12048 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12049 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012050 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12051 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12052 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012053
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012054tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12055 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012056 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12057 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12058 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12059 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12060 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12061 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12062 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12063 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12064 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12065 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012066 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12067 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12068
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012069transparent
12070 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12071 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12072 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12073 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12074 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12075 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12076 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12077 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12078 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12079 so check for support with your vendor.
12080
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012081v4v6
12082 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12083 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12084 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12085 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012086 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012087
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012088v6only
12089 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12090 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12091 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012092 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12093 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012094
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012095uid <uid>
12096 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12097 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12098 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12099 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12100 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12101
12102user <user>
12103 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12104 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12105 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12106 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12107 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12108
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012109verify [none|optional|required]
12110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12111 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12112 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12113 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12114 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012115 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12116 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12117 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12118 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200121205.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012121------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012123The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12124which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12125arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12126settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12127after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12128Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12129address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012131 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012132 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012133
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012134Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12135keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12136
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012137The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012138
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012139addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012140 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012141 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12142 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12143 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12144 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12145 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012146
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012147agent-check
12148 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012149 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012150 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12151 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12152 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012153
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012154 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012155 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012156 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12157 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12158 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012159
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012160 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12161 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12162 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12163 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12164 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012165
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012166 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012167 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012168
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012169 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12170 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12171 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012172
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012173 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12174 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12175 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012176
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012177 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12178 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12179 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12180 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12181 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012182 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012183 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012184
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012185 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12186 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012187
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012188 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12189 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12190 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12191 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12192 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12193 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12194 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12195 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12196 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012197
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012198 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12199 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012200 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12201 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12202 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012203 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012204
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012205 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012206 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012207
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012208agent-send <string>
12209 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12210 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12211 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12212 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12213 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12214
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012215agent-inter <delay>
12216 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12217 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12218
12219 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12220 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12221 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12222 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12223 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12224 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12225 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12226 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12227 of backends use the same servers.
12228
12229 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12230
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012231agent-addr <addr>
12232 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12233
12234 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12235 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12236 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12237 hostname, it will be resolved.
12238
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012239agent-port <port>
12240 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12241
12242 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12243
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012244allow-0rtt
12245 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012246 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12247 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012248
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012249alpn <protocols>
12250 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12251 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12252 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012253 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012254 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12255 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12256 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12257 now obsolete NPN extension.
12258 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12259 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12260
12261 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012263backup
12264 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12265 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12266 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12267 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012268 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12269 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012270
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012271ca-file <cafile>
12272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12273 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12274 server's certificate.
12275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012276check
12277 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012278 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12279 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12280 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12281 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12282 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12283 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12284 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012285 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12286 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012287 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12288 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012289
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012290check-send-proxy
12291 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12292 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12293 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12294 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12295 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12296 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12297 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12298
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012299check-alpn <protocols>
12300 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12301 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12302 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12303
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012304check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012305 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012306 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12307 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012308
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012309check-ssl
12310 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12311 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12312 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12313 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012314 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012315 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12316 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012317 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012318 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12319 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012320
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012321check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012322 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012323 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12324 for normal traffic.
12325
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012326ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12328 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12329 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012330 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12331 information and recommendations see e.g.
12332 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12333 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12334 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012335
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012336ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12337 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12338 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12339 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12340 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012341 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12342 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12343 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012345cookie <value>
12346 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12347 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12348 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12349 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12350 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12351 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12352 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12353
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012354crl-file <crlfile>
12355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12356 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12357 to verify server's certificate.
12358
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012359crt <cert>
12360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12361 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12362 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12363 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12364 certificate request.
12365
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012366disabled
12367 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12368 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12369 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12370 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12371 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012372 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012373
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012374enabled
12375 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12376 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12377 default value.
12378 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12379 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012381error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012382 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12383 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12384 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012386 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012388fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012389 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12390 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12391 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12392
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012393force-sslv3
12394 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12395 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012396 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012397 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012398
12399force-tlsv10
12400 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012401 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012402 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012403
12404force-tlsv11
12405 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012406 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012407 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012408
12409force-tlsv12
12410 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012411 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012412 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012413
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012414force-tlsv13
12415 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12416 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012417 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012419id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012420 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12421 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12422 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012423
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012424init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12425 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12426 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012427 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012428 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12429 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12430 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12431 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12432 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12433 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12434 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12435 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12436 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012437 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012438 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12439 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12440 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12441 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12442 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12443 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012444 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012445
12446 Example:
12447 defaults
12448 # never fail on address resolution
12449 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012451inter <delay>
12452fastinter <delay>
12453downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012454 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12455 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12456 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12457 between checks depending on the server state :
12458
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012459 Server state | Interval used
12460 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12461 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12462 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12463 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12464 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12465 or yet unchecked. |
12466 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12467 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12468 | "inter" otherwise.
12469 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012471 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12472 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12473 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12474 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012475 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12476 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12477 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12478 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12479 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012481maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012482 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12483 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012484 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12485 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012486 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12487 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12488 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12489 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12490
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012491 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12492 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12493 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12494 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12495 than 50 concurrent requests.
12496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012497maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012498 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12499 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12500 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12501 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12502 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12503 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12504 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12505
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012506max-reuse <count>
12507 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12508 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12509 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12510 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12511 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12512 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12513 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12514 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012516minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012517 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12518 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12519 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12520 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12521 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12522 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012523 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012524 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012525
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012526namespace <name>
12527 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12528 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12529 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12530 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12531
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012532no-agent-check
12533 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12534 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12535 default value.
12536 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12537 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12538
12539no-backup
12540 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12541 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12542 default value.
12543 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12544 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12545
12546no-check
12547 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12548 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12549 default value.
12550 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12551 "default-server" "check" setting.
12552
12553no-check-ssl
12554 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12555 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12556 default value.
12557 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12558 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12559
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012560no-send-proxy
12561 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12562 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12563 default value.
12564 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12565 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12566
12567no-send-proxy-v2
12568 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12569 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12570 default value.
12571 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12572 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12573
12574no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12575 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12576 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12577 default value.
12578 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12579 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12580
12581no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12582 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12583 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12584 default value.
12585 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12586 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12587
12588no-ssl
12589 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12590 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12591 default value.
12592 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12593 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12594
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012595no-ssl-reuse
12596 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12597 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12598 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12599 and for paranoid users.
12600
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012601no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012602 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12603 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012604 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012605
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012606 Supported in default-server: No
12607
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012608no-tls-tickets
12609 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12610 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12611 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012612 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12613 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012614 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12615 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12616 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012617 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012618
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012619no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012620 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012621 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12622 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012623 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12624 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012625 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012626
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012627 Supported in default-server: No
12628
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012629no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012630 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012631 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12632 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012633 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12634 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012635 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012636
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012637 Supported in default-server: No
12638
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012639no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012640 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012641 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12642 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012643 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12644 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012645 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012646
12647 Supported in default-server: No
12648
12649no-tlsv13
12650 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12651 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12652 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12653 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12654 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012655 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012656
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012657 Supported in default-server: No
12658
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012659no-verifyhost
12660 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12661 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12662 default value.
12663 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12664 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012665
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012666no-tfo
12667 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12668 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12669 default value.
12670 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12671 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12672
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012673non-stick
12674 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12675 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12676 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12677
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012678npn <protocols>
12679 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12680 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12681 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012682 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012683 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12684 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12685 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12686
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012687observe <mode>
12688 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12689 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12690 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12691 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12692 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12693 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012694 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012695
12696 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012698on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012699 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12700 Currently, four modes are available:
12701 - fastinter: force fastinter
12702 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12703 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12704 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12705 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12706
12707 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12708
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012709on-marked-down <action>
12710 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12711 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012712 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12713 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12714 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12715 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12716 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12717 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12718 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12719 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012720
12721 Actions are disabled by default
12722
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012723on-marked-up <action>
12724 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12725 Currently one action is available:
12726 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12727 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12728 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12729 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012730 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12731 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012732 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12733 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12734
12735 Actions are disabled by default
12736
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012737pool-max-conn <max>
12738 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12739 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12740 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12741 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12742 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12743 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12744
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012745pool-purge-delay <delay>
12746 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012747 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012748 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012750port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012751 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12752 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12753 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12754 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12755 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12756 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12757
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012758proto <name>
12759
12760 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12761 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12762 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12763 reported in haproxy -vv.
12764 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12765 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012767redir <prefix>
12768 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12769 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12770 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12771 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12772 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12773 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12774 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12775 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012776 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012777 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012778 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12779 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12780 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12781 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12782
12783 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012785rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012786 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12787 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12788 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12789
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012790resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12791 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12792 server.
12793
12794 Available options:
12795
12796 * allow-dup-ip
12797 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12798 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12799 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12800 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12801 For such case, simply enable this option.
12802 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12803
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012804 * ignore-weight
12805 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12806 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12807 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12808
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012809 * prevent-dup-ip
12810 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12811 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12812 same fqdn.
12813 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12814
12815 Example:
12816 backend b_myapp
12817 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12818 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12819 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12820
12821 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12822 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12823 it
12824 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12825 different address
12826
12827 Default value: not set
12828
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012829resolve-prefer <family>
12830 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12831 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12832 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12833 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12834
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012835 Default value: ipv6
12836
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012837 Example:
12838
12839 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012840
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012841resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012842 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012843 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012844 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012845 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12846 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012847 configured network, another address is selected.
12848
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012849 Example:
12850
12851 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012852
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012853resolvers <id>
12854 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12855 hostname.
12856
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012857 Example:
12858
12859 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012860
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012861 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012862
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012863send-proxy
12864 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12865 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12866 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12867 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012868 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12869 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12870 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12871 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12872 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12873 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12874 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12875 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12876 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12877 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012878 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12879 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012880
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012881send-proxy-v2
12882 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12883 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12884 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12885 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012886 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12887 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12888 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12889 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012890
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012891proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010012892 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
12893 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
12894
12895 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
12896 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
12897 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
12898 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
12899 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
12900 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
12901 connection is supported).
12902 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
12903 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
12904 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
12905 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
12906 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
12907 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
12908 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012909
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012910send-proxy-v2-ssl
12911 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12912 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12913 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12914 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12915 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12916 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12917 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012918 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12919 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012920
12921send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12922 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12923 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12924 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12925 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12926 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12927 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12928 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12929 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012930 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12931 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012933slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012934 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12935 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12936 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12937 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12938 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12939 parameters :
12940
12941 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12942 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12943
12944 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12945 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12946 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12947 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12948
12949 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12950 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12951 seen as failed.
12952
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012953sni <expression>
12954 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12955 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12956 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12957 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012958 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12959 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012960 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012961 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12962 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012963
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012964source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012965source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012966source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012967 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12968 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12969 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12970 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12971
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012972 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12973 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12974 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12975 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12976 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12977 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12978 server.
12979
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012980 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12981 specifying the source address without port(s).
12982
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012983ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012984 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12985 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12986 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12987 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12988 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12989 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012990 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12991 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012992
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012993ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12994 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12995 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12996 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12997
12998ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12999 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13000 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13001 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13002
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013003ssl-reuse
13004 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13005 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13006 default value.
13007 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13008 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13009
13010stick
13011 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13012 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13013 default value.
13014 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13015 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013016
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013017socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013018 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013019 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13020 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13021
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013022tcp-ut <delay>
13023 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13024 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13025 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013026 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013027 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13028 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13029 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13030 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13031 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13032 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13033 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13034 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13035 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13036
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013037tfo
13038 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13039 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13040 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13041 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13042 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013043 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013045track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013046 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13047 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13048 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13049 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013050 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13051
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013052tls-tickets
13053 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13054 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13055 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013056 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13057 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13058 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013059 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013060 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013061
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013062verify [none|required]
13063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013064 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013065 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13066 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013067 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013068 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13069 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13070 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13071 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13072 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13073 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13074 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13075 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013076
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013077verifyhost <hostname>
13078 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013079 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13080 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13081 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13082 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13083 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13084 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13085 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13086 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013088weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013089 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13090 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13091 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013092 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13093 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13094 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13095 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13096 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13097 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013098
13099
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200131005.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13101-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013102
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013103HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13104using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13105configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013106This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13107can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13108workload.
13109This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13110resolution at run time.
13111Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13112carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13113
13114
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200131155.3.1. Global overview
13116----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013117
13118As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13119different steps of the process life:
13120
13121 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13122 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13123 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13124
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013125 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13126 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013127
13128A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13129 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13130 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13131 resolution to know this new IP.
13132
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013133When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013134HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013135SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13136from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13137will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13138will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013139
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013140A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013141 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013142 first valid response.
13143
13144 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13145 servers return an error.
13146
13147
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200131485.3.2. The resolvers section
13149----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013150
13151This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013152HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13153contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013154
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013155When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13156uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13157is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13158answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13159
13160When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013161used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013162
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013163 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13164 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13165 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013166
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013167 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13168 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013169
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013170 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13171 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13172 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013173
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013174For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13175following scenarios are possible:
13176
13177 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13178 ignored
13179
13180 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13181 applied
13182
13183 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13184 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13185
13186 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13187 retries the query with a new type
13188
13189 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13190 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013191
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013192As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13193a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013194<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013195
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013196
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013197resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013198 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013199
13200A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13201
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013202accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013203 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013204 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013205 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13206 by RFC 6891)
13207
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013208 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13209
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013210nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13211 DNS server description:
13212 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13213 <ip> : IP address of the server
13214 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13215
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013216parse-resolv-conf
13217 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13218 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13219 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13220
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013221hold <status> <period>
13222 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13223 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013224 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013225 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013226 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13227 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13228 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13229
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013230 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013231
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013232resolve_retries <nb>
13233 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13234 giving up.
13235 Default value: 3
13236
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013237 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13238 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13239 type.
13240
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013241timeout <event> <time>
13242 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13243 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13244 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013245 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13246 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013247 Default value: 1s
13248 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013249 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013250 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013251 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13252 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13253
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013254 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013255
13256 resolvers mydns
13257 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13258 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013259 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013260 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013261 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013262 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013263 hold other 30s
13264 hold refused 30s
13265 hold nx 30s
13266 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013267 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013268 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013269
13270
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200132716. Cache
13272---------
13273
13274HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13275(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13276RAM.
13277
13278The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13279this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13280
13281If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13282independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13283when we try to allocate a new one.
13284
13285The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13286
13287It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13288"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13289for more details.
13290
13291When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13292replaced by "<CACHE>".
13293
13294
132956.1. Limitation
13296----------------
13297
13298The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13299
13300- If the response is not a 200
13301- If the response contains a Vary header
13302- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13303- If the response is not cacheable
13304
13305- If the request is not a GET
13306- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13307- If the request contains an Authorization header
13308
13309
133106.2. Setup
13311-----------
13312
13313To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13314the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13315
13316
133176.2.1. Cache section
13318---------------------
13319
13320cache <name>
13321 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13322 size of cache is mandatory.
13323
13324total-max-size <megabytes>
13325 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13326 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13327
13328max-object-size <bytes>
13329 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13330 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13331 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13332
13333max-age <seconds>
13334 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13335 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13336 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13337 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13338 default.
13339
13340
133416.2.2. Proxy section
13342---------------------
13343
13344http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13345 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13346 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13347 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13348 after this one.
13349
13350http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13351 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13352 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13353 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13354 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13355
13356
13357Example:
13358
13359 backend bck1
13360 mode http
13361
13362 http-request cache-use foobar
13363 http-response cache-store foobar
13364 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13365
13366 cache foobar
13367 total-max-size 4
13368 max-age 240
13369
13370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133717. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13372----------------------------------
13373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013374HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13376The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13377these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13378but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13379data called patterns.
13380
13381
133827.1. ACL basics
13383---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013384
13385The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13386content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13387from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13388simple :
13389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013391 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013392 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13393 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013395The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13396adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013397
13398In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013400 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013401
13402This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13403Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13404and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013405an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13406conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13407as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13408are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013409
13410ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13411'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13412which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13413
13414There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13415performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013417The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13418specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13419this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013420methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13421ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013422
13423Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13424 - boolean
13425 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13426 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13427 - string
13428 - data block
13429
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013430Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13431converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13432would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13433The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13434which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13435
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013436Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13437keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13438fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13439which are summarized in the table below :
13440
13441 +---------------------+-----------------+
13442 | Sample or converter | Default |
13443 | output type | matching method |
13444 +---------------------+-----------------+
13445 | boolean | bool |
13446 +---------------------+-----------------+
13447 | integer | int |
13448 +---------------------+-----------------+
13449 | ip | ip |
13450 +---------------------+-----------------+
13451 | string | str |
13452 +---------------------+-----------------+
13453 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13454 +---------------------+-----------------+
13455
13456Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13457matching method, see below.
13458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013459The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13460 - boolean
13461 - integer or integer range
13462 - IP address / network
13463 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13464 - regular expression
13465 - hex block
13466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013467The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13468
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013469 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13470 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013471 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013472 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013473 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013474 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013475 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013477The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13478read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13479if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13480lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13481will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13482beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13483a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13484lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13485exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13486
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013487The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13488parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13489ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13490a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13491check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13492
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013493The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13494socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13495file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013497Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13498loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13499
13500 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13501
13502In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13503the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13504case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13505as well.
13506
13507The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13508sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13509do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13510methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13511is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013512obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013513followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13514default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13515that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13516string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13517
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013518The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13519By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13520string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13521resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13522server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013523waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013524flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13525function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013527There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13528sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13529be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013530
13531 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13532 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013533 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13534 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13535 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13536 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013537
13538 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13539 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013540 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013541
13542 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013544
13545 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013546 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013547
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013548 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013549 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13550
13551 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13552 binary or string samples.
13553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13555 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013557 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13558 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13559 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013561 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13562 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013564 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13565 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013567 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13568 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013570 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13571 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013572 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013574 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13575 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13576 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013577
13578For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13579request, it is possible to do :
13580
13581 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13582
13583In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13584buffer, one would use the following acl :
13585
13586 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13587
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013588On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13589possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13590
13591 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013593All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13594criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13595method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13596to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13597criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13598the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013600If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013601the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13602For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013604 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13605 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13606 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13607 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013608
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013609
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013610The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13611types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13612combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13613brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13614default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616 +-------------------------------------------------+
13617 | Input sample type |
13618 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013619 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013620 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13621 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13622 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013623 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013625 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013626 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013627 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013628 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013629 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013630 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013631 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013632 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013633 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013634 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013635 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013636 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013637 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013638 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013639 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013640 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013641 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013642 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013643 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013644 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13645 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13646 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013647
13648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136497.1.1. Matching booleans
13650------------------------
13651
13652In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13653Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13654When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13655that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13656
13657Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13658return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13659"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136627.1.2. Matching integers
13663------------------------
13664
13665Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13666enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13667to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13668
13669Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13670matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13671lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013672
13673For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13674unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13675representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13676
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013677As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13678two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13679instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13680ranges and operators.
13681
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013682For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013683operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13684Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13685of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013687Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013688
13689 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13690 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13691 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13692 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13693 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013695For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013696
13697 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13698
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013699This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13700
13701 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137047.1.3. Matching strings
13705-----------------------
13706
13707String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13708different forms :
13709
13710 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013711 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013712
13713 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013714 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013715
13716 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13717 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13718
13719 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13720 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13721
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013722 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013723 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13724 matches.
13725
13726 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13727 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13728 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013729
13730String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13731exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13732characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13733string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13734to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013735before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013736
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013737Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13738(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13739Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13740
13741Example:
13742 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13743 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13744
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137467.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13747---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013748
13749Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13750they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13751possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13752passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13753the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013754the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13755match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013756
13757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137587.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13759-------------------------------------
13760
13761It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13762not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13763a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13764to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13765digits may be used upper or lower case.
13766
13767Example :
13768 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13769 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13770
13771
137727.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13773---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013774
13775IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13776netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13777within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013778host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013779difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13780at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13781does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13782parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013783
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013784The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13785abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13786
13787 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13788 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13789 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13790 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13791 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13792 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13793 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13794 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13795
13796Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13797192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13798
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013799IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13800Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13801trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13802IPv6 patterns.
13803
13804HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13805following situations :
13806 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13807 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13808 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13809 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13810 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13811 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13812 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13813 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13814 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13815 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013817
138187.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13819----------------------------------
13820
13821Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13822combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13823
13824 - AND (implicit)
13825 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13826 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013828A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013830 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013832Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13833indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013835For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13836"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13837requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13838is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13839
13840 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013841 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13842 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13843 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013844
13845To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13846and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13847
13848 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13849 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13850 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13851 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13852
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013853 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013854 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13855 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13856 use_backend www if host_www
13857
13858It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13859expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13860be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13861the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13862
13863 The following rule :
13864
13865 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013866 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013867
13868 Can also be written that way :
13869
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013870 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013871
13872It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13873to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13874simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13875sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13876good use is the following :
13877
13878 With named ACLs :
13879
13880 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13881 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13882 monitor fail if site_dead
13883
13884 With anonymous ACLs :
13885
13886 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13887
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013888See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13889keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013890
13891
138927.3. Fetching samples
13893---------------------
13894
13895Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13896against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13897sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13898ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13899of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13900available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13901
13902This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13903Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13904compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13905deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13906
13907The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13908matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13909method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13910indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13911
13912As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13913when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13914mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13915the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13916ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13917
13918Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13919multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13920when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013921incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13922are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013923is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13924all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13925
13926Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13927 - name
13928 - name(arg1)
13929 - name(arg1,arg2)
13930
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013931
139327.3.1. Converters
13933-----------------
13934
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013935Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13936of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13937is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13938was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013939has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013940unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13941
13942These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13943sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13944the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013945support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013946
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013947A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13948support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13949supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13950(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13951bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013953The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013954
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001395551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13956 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13957 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13958 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13959 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13960 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13961
13962 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013963 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13964 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013965 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13966 frontend http-in
13967 bind *:8081
13968 default_backend servers
13969 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13970 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13971
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013972add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013973 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013974 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013975 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13976 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013977 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013978 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13979 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13980 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13981 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013982 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013983 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013984
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013985aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13986 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13987 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13988 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13989 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13990 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13991 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13992
13993 Example:
13994 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13995 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13996
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013997and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013998 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013999 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014000 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14001 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014002 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014003 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14004 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14005 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14006 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014007 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014008 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014009
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014010b64dec
14011 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14012 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14013
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014014base64
14015 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014016 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014017 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14018
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014019bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014020 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014021 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014022 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014023 presence of a flag).
14024
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014025bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14026 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14027 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014028 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014029
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014030concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14031 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14032 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14033 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14034 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14035 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14036 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14037 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14038 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14039 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14040 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014041 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14042 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14043 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14044 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014045
14046 Example:
14047 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14048 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14049 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014050 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014051 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14052
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014053cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014054 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14055 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014056
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014057crc32([<avalanche>])
14058 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14059 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14060 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14061 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14062 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14063 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14064 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14065 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14066 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14067 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014068 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14069
14070crc32c([<avalanche>])
14071 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14072 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14073 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14074 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14075 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14076 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14077 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14078 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014079
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014080cut_crlf
14081 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14082 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14083 updated.
14084
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014085da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014086 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14087 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14088 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14089 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014090 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014091 configuration language.
14092
14093 Example:
14094 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014095 bind *:8881
14096 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014097 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014098
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014099debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14100 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14101 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14102 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14103 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14104 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14105 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14106 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14107 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14108 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14109 printable sample types.
14110
14111 Example:
14112 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014113
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014114div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014115 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14116 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014117 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014118 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14119 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014120 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014121 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14122 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14123 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14124 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014125 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014126 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014127
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014128djb2([<avalanche>])
14129 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14130 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14131 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14132 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14133 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14134 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14135 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014136 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14137 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014138
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014139even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014140 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014141 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14142
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014143field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14144 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14145 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14146 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14147 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14148 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14149 fields.
14150
14151 Example :
14152 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14153 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14154 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14155 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14156 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014157
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014158hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014159 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014160 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014161 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014162 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014163
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014164hex2i
14165 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014166 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014167
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014168htonl
14169 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14170 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14171 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14172 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14173
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014174http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014175 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14176 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014177 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14178 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14179 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14180 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14181 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14182 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14183 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14184 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014185
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014186in_table(<table>)
14187 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14188 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14189 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014190 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014191 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14192
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014193ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14194 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014195 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014196 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14197 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14198 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14199 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14200 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014201
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014202json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014203 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014204 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014205 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014206 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14207 of errors:
14208 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14209 bytes, ...)
14210 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14211 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14212
14213 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14214 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14215 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14216 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14217 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14218 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014219 - "ascii" : never fails;
14220 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14221 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014222 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014223 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014224 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14225 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14226
14227 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014228 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014229
14230 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014231 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014232 capture request header user-agent len 150
14233 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014234
14235 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14236 GET / HTTP/1.0
14237 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14238
14239 Output log:
14240 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14241
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014242language(<value>[,<default>])
14243 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14244 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14245 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14246 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14247 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14248 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14249 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14250 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14251 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014252 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014253 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14254 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014255
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014256 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014257
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014258 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14259 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014260
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014261 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14262 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14263 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14264 use_backend spanish if es
14265 use_backend french if fr
14266 use_backend english if en
14267 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014268
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014269length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014270 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14271 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14272 type. The result is of type integer.
14273
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014274lower
14275 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14276 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14277 type. The result is of type string.
14278
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014279ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14280 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14281 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14282 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14283 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14284 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14285 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14286
14287 Example :
14288
14289 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014290 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014291 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14292
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014293ltrim(<chars>)
14294 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14295 representation of the input sample.
14296
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014297map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14298map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14299map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14300 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14301 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14302 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14303 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14304 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14305 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14306 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14307 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014308
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014309 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14310 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14311 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014312
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014313 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014314 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014315
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014316 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14317 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14318 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14319 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014320 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14321 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014322 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14323 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14324 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14325 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14326 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14327 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14328 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14329 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014330 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14331 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14332 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014333 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14334 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14335 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14336 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14337 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014338
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014339 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14340 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14341 the corresponding match text.
14342
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014343 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14344 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14345 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14346 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14347 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014348
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014349 Example :
14350
14351 # this is a comment and is ignored
14352 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14353 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14354 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14355 | | | `---------- value
14356 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14357 | `---------------------------- key
14358 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14359
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014360mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014361 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14362 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014363 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014364 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14368 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14369 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014370 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014371 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014372
14373mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014374 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014375 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14376 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014377 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014378 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014379 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014380 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14381 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14382 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14383 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014384 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014385 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014386
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014387nbsrv
14388 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14389 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14390 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14391 map lookup.
14392
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014393neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014394 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14395 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14396 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14397 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014398
14399not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014400 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014401 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014402 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014403 absence of a flag).
14404
14405odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014406 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014407 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14408
14409or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014410 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014411 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014412 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14413 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014414 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014415 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14416 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14417 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14418 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014419 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014420 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014421
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014422protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14423 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14424 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14425 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14426 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14427 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14428 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14429 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14430 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14431 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14432 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14433 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14434
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014435regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014436 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14437 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14438 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14439 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14440 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14441 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14442 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14443 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14444 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014445 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14446 of characters with other ones.
14447
14448 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14449 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14450 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14451 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14452 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14453 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014454
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014455 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014456
14457 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14458 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14459 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014460 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014461
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014462 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14463 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14464
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014465 # capture groups and backreferences
14466 # both lines do the same.
14467 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14468 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14469
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014470capture-req(<id>)
14471 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14472 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14473
14474 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014475 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14476 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014477
14478capture-res(<id>)
14479 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14480 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14481
14482 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014483 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14484 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014485
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020014486rtrim(<chars>)
14487 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
14488 of the input sample.
14489
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014490sdbm([<avalanche>])
14491 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14492 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14493 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14494 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14495 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14496 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14497 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014498 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14499 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014500
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014501set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014502 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14503 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14504 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014505 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014506 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14507 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014508 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014509 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14510 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014511 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014512 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014513
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014514sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014515 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014516 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14517
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014518sha2([<bits>])
14519 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14520 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14521
14522 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14523 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14524
14525 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14526 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14527
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014528srv_queue
14529 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14530 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14531 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14532 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14533 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14534
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014535strcmp(<var>)
14536 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14537 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14538 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14539 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14540 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14541 shorter).
14542
14543 Example :
14544
14545 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14546 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14547 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14548
14549
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014550sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014551 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14552 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014553 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014554 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14555 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014556 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014557 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14558 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014559 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014560 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14561 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014562 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014563 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014564
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014565table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14566 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14567 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14568 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14569 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14570 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14571 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14572
14573
14574table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14575 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14576 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14577 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14578 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14579 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14580 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14581
14582table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14583 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14584 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014585 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014586 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14587 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14588
14589table_conn_cur(<table>)
14590 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14591 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14592 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14593 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14594 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14595
14596table_conn_rate(<table>)
14597 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14598 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14599 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14600 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14601 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14602
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014603table_gpt0(<table>)
14604 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14605 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14606 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14607 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14608 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14609
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014610table_gpc0(<table>)
14611 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14612 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14613 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14614 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14615 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14616
14617table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14618 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14619 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14620 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14621 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14622 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14623 sample fetch keyword.
14624
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014625table_gpc1(<table>)
14626 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14627 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14628 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14629 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14630 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14631
14632table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14633 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14634 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14635 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14636 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14637 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14638 sample fetch keyword.
14639
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014640table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14641 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14642 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014643 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014644 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14645 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14646
14647table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14648 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14649 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14650 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14651 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14652 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14653 keyword.
14654
14655table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14656 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14657 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014658 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014659 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14660 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14661
14662table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14663 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14664 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14665 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14666 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14667 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14668 keyword.
14669
14670table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14671 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14672 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014673 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014674 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14675 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14676 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14677 keyword.
14678
14679table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14680 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14681 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014682 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014683 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14684 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14685 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14686 keyword.
14687
14688table_server_id(<table>)
14689 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14690 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14691 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14692 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14693 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14694 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14695
14696table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14697 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14698 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014699 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014700 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14701 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14702 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14703 keyword.
14704
14705table_sess_rate(<table>)
14706 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14707 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14708 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14709 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14710 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14711 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14712 keyword.
14713
14714table_trackers(<table>)
14715 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14716 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14717 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14718 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14719 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14720 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14721 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14722 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14723 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14724 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14725
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014726upper
14727 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14728 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14729 type. The result is of type string.
14730
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014731url_dec([<in_form>])
14732 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14733 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14734 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14735 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14736 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14737 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014738
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014739ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014740 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014741 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14742 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14743 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014744 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14745 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14746 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14747 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014748 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014749 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14750 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014751
14752 Example:
14753 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14754 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14755
14756 message Point {
14757 int32 latitude = 1;
14758 int32 longitude = 2;
14759 }
14760
14761 message PPoint {
14762 Point point = 59;
14763 }
14764
14765 message Rectangle {
14766 // One corner of the rectangle.
14767 PPoint lo = 48;
14768 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14769 PPoint hi = 49;
14770 }
14771
14772 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14773 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14774 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14775
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014776 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14777 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014778 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014779 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14780
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014781 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014782
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014783 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014784
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014785 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014786 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14787 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14788
14789 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14790 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14791 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14792
14793 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14794 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14795 interpret the previous binary sample.
14796
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014797
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014798unset-var(<var name>)
14799 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14800 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14801 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14802 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14803 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14804 response),
14805 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14806 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14807 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14808 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14809
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014810utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14811 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14812 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14813 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14814 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14815 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14816 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14817
14818 Example :
14819
14820 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014821 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014822 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14823
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014824word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14825 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14826 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14827 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014828 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014829 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14830 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14831
14832 Example :
14833 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14834 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14835 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14836 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14837 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014838 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014839
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014840wt6([<avalanche>])
14841 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14842 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14843 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14844 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14845 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14846 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14847 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014848 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14849 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014850
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014851xor(<value>)
14852 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014853 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014854 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014855 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014856 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014857 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14858 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014859 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014860 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14861 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014863 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014864
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014865xxh32([<seed>])
14866 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14867 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14868 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14869 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14870 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14871 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14872 as cryptographically secure.
14873
14874xxh64([<seed>])
14875 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14876 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14877 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14878 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14879 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14880 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14881 as cryptographically secure.
14882
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014883
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014885--------------------------------------------
14886
14887A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14888not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14889"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14890The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14891
14892always_false : boolean
14893 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14894 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14895
14896always_true : boolean
14897 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14898 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14899
14900avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014901 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14903 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14904 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14905 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14906 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14907 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14908 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14909 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14910 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14911 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14912 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14913 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14914 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014917 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14918 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14919 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14920 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014921 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14922
14923be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14924 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14925 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14926 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14927 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14928 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014929 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14930 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014931
14932 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14933 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14934 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014936be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14937 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14938 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14939 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014940 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014941 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14942 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014943
14944 Example :
14945 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14946 backend dynamic
14947 mode http
14948 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14949 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014950
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014951bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014952 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14953 of the string.
14954
14955bool(<bool>) : bool
14956 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14957 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014959connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14960 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014961 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014962 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14963 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014964
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014965 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014966 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014967 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14968
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014969 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14970 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014971
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014972 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014973 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014974 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014975 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014976 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014977 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014978 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014979
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014980 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14981 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014982 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014983 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014984
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014985cpu_calls : integer
14986 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14987 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14988 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14989 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14990 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14991 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14992
14993cpu_ns_avg : integer
14994 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14995 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14996 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14997 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14998 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14999 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15000 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15001 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15002 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15003 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15004 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15005
15006cpu_ns_tot : integer
15007 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15008 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15009 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15010 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15011 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15012 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15013 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15014 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15015 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15016 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15017 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15018 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15019 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15020
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015021date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015022 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015023
15024 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15025 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15026 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015027 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15028
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015029 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15030 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15031 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15032 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15033 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15034
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015035 Example :
15036
15037 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15038 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015039
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015040 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15041 # millisecond granularity
15042 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15043
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015044date_us : integer
15045 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15046 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15047 from the same timeval structure.
15048
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015049distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15050 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15051 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15052 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15053 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15054 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15055 list of supported tokens.
15056
15057distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15058 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15059 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15060 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15061 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15062 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15063 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15064 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15065 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15066 supported tokens.
15067
15068 Example :
15069 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15070 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15071 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15072 # send large files to the big farm
15073 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15074
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015075env(<name>) : string
15076 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15077 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15078 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15079 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15080 certain way.
15081
15082 Examples :
15083 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15084 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15085
15086 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15087 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015089fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15090 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015091 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15092 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15094 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015095 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015096 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15097 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015098
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015099fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15100 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15101 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15102 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15105 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15106 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15107 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15108 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15109 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15110 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15111 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15112 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015113
15114 Example :
15115 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15116 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15117 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15118 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15119 frontend mail
15120 bind :25
15121 mode tcp
15122 maxconn 100
15123 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15124 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15125 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15126 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015127
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015128hostname : string
15129 Returns the system hostname.
15130
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015131int(<integer>) : signed integer
15132 Returns a signed integer.
15133
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015134ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15135 Returns an ipv4.
15136
15137ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15138 Returns an ipv6.
15139
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015140lat_ns_avg : integer
15141 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15142 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15143 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15144 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15145 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15146 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15147 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15148 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15149 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15150 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15151 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15152 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15153 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15154 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15155
15156lat_ns_tot : integer
15157 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15158 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15159 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15160 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15161 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15162 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15163 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15164 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15165 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15166 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15167 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15168 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15169 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15170 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15171 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15172 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15173 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15174 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15175 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15176
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015177meth(<method>) : method
15178 Returns a method.
15179
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015180nbproc : integer
15181 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15182 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15183 and debugging purposes.
15184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015185nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15186 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15187 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15188 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015189 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15190 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15191 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015192
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015193prio_class : integer
15194 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15195 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15196 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15197
15198prio_offset : integer
15199 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15200 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15201 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15202 set-priority-offset".
15203
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015204proc : integer
15205 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15206 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15207 debugging purposes.
15208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015210 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15211 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15212 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15214 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15215 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15216 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15217 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15218
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015219rand([<range>]) : integer
15220 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15221 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15222 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15223 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15224 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15225
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015226uuid([<version>]) : string
15227 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15228 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15229 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15232 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15233 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15234 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15235 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15236 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015237 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15238 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15239
15240srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15241 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15242 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15243 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15244 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15245 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15246 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15247 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15248
15249 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15250 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251
15252srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15253 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15254 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15255 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015256 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015257 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15258 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15259 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15260
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015261srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15262 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15263 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15264 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15265 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15266 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15267 fetch methods.
15268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15270 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15271 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015272 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015273 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15274 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015275 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276 overloading servers).
15277
15278 Example :
15279 # Redirect to a separate back
15280 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15281 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15282 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15283
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015284stopping : boolean
15285 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15286 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15287 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15288
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015289str(<string>) : string
15290 Returns a string.
15291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015292table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15293 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15294 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15295
15296table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15297 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15298 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15299 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15300
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015301thread : integer
15302 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15303 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15304 and debugging purposes.
15305
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015306var(<var-name>) : undefined
15307 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015308 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15309 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015310 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015311 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15312 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015313 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015314 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15315 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015316 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015317 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015318
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153197.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320----------------------------------
15321
15322The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15323closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15324methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15325sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15326TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015327the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15328counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015329"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15330used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15331can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15332Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15333table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15334tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15335currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015336
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015337bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015338 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15339 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15340 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015342be_id : integer
15343 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15344 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15345
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015346be_name : string
15347 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15348 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350dst : ip
15351 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15352 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15353 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15354 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015355 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15356 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15357 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15358 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15359 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15360 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015361
15362dst_conn : integer
15363 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15364 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15365 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15366 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15367 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15368 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15369 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15370 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015371
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015372dst_is_local : boolean
15373 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15374 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15375 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15376 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015377 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015378 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15379 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15380 it only once per connection.
15381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382dst_port : integer
15383 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15384 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15385 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15386 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15387 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15388 an HTTP header.
15389
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015390fc_http_major : integer
15391 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15392 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15393 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15394
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015395fc_pp_authority : string
15396 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15397 if any.
15398
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015399fc_pp_unique_id : string
15400 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15401 if any.
15402
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015403fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15404 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15405 header.
15406
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015407fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15408 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15409 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15410 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15411 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15412 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15413 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15414
15415fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15416 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15417 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15418 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15419 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15420 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15421 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15422
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015423fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015424 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15425 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15426 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15427 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15428
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015429fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015430 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15431 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15432 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15433 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15434
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015435fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015436 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15437 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15438 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15439 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15440
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015441fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015442 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15443 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15444 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15445 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15446
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015447fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015448 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15449 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15450 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15451 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15452
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015453fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015454 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15455 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15456 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15457 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15458
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015459fe_defbe : string
15460 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15461 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463fe_id : integer
15464 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015465 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15467
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015468fe_name : string
15469 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15470 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15471 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15472
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015473sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015474sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15475sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15476sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015477 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15478 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15479 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15480
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015481sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015482sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15483sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15484sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015485 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15486 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15487 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15488
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015489sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015490sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15491sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15492sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015493 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15494 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015495 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15496 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15497 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015498
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015499 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015500 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15501 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015502 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15503 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15504 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015505 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15506 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15507
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015508sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15509sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15510sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15511sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15512 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15513 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15514 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15515 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15516 when a first ACL was verified.
15517
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015518sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015519sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15520sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15521sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015522 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015523 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15524
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015525sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015526sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15527sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15528sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015529 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15530 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15531 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15532
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015533sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015534sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15535sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15536sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015537 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15538 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15539 See also src_conn_rate.
15540
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015541sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015542sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15543sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15544sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015545 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015546 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015547
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015548sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15549sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15550sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15551sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15552 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15553 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15554
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015555sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15556sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15557sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15558sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15559 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15560 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15561
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015562sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015563sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15564sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15565sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015566 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15567 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15568 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015569 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15570 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15571 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015572
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015573sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15574sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15575sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15576sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15577 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15578 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15579 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15580 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15581 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15582 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15583
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015584sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015585sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15586sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15587sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015588 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015589 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15590 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15591
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015592sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015593sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15594sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15595sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015596 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15597 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15598 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15599 src_http_err_rate.
15600
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015601sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015602sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15603sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15604sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015605 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015606 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15607 src_http_req_cnt.
15608
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015609sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015610sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15611sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15612sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015613 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15614 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15615 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15616 src_http_req_rate.
15617
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015618sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015619sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15620sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15621sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015622 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015623 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15624 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15625 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15626 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015627
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015628 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015629 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15630 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015631 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15632
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015633sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15634sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15635sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15636sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15637 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15638 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15639 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15640 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15641 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15642
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015643sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015644sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15645sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15646sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015647 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15648 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15649 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015650
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015651sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015652sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15653sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15654sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015655 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15656 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15657 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015658
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015659sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015660sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15661sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15662sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015663 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015664 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15665 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15666 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015667 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015668 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15669
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015670sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015671sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15672sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15673sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015674 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15675 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15676 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15677 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15678 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015679 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015680
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015681sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015682sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15683sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15684sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015685 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15686 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15687 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15688
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015689sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015690sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15691sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15692sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015693 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15694 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015695 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015696 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15697 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15699 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15700 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702so_id : integer
15703 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15704 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15705 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015706
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015707so_name : string
15708 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15709 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15710 strings instead of integers.
15711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015713 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15715 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15716 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015717 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15718 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15719 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015720 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15721 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15722 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15723 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15724 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15725 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15726 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015727
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015728 Example:
15729 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15730 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15733 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15734 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15735 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015736 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15739 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15740 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015741 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015742 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15745 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15746 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15747 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15748 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15749 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15750 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015751
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015752 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015753 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15754 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15755 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15756 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015757 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015758 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15759 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15760
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015761src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15762 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15763 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15764 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15765 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15766 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15767 was verified.
15768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015770 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015772 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015773 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015776 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015777 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15778 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015779 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015781src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15782 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15783 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15784 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015785 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015787src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015788 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015789 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015790 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015791 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015792
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015793src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15794 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15795 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15796 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15797 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15798
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015799src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15800 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15801 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15802 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15803 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015806 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015808 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15809 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015810 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15811 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15812 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015813
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015814src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15815 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15816 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15817 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15818 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15819 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15820 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15821 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015824 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015826 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015827 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015828 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15831 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15832 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15833 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15834 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015835 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015838 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015839 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15840 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015841 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15844 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15845 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15846 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015847 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015848 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15851 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15852 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15853 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015854 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15856 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015857
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015858 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015859 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015860 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015861 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015862
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015863src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15864 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15865 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15866 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15867 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15868 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15869 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15870
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015871src_is_local : boolean
15872 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15873 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15874 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15875 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015876 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015877 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15878 once per connection.
15879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015881 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15882 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15883 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15884 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15885 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015888 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15889 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15890 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15891 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15892 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894src_port : integer
15895 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15896 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15897 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15898 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015901 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015902 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15903 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15904 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015905 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015907src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15908 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15909 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15910 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15911 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015912 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15915 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15916 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15917 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15918 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15919 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15920 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15921 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15922 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015923
15924 Example :
15925 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15926 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15927 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15928 listen ssh
15929 bind :22
15930 mode tcp
15931 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015932 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015934 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936srv_id : integer
15937 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15938 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15939 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015940
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015941srv_name : string
15942 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15943 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15944 debugging.
15945
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159467.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15950closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15951when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15952usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015953future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015954
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001595551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15956 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15957 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15958 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15959 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15960 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15961
15962 Example :
15963 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15964 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15965 # the request.
15966 frontend http-in
15967 bind *:8081
15968 default_backend servers
15969 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15970 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15971
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015972ssl_bc : boolean
15973 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15974 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15975 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15976
15977ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15978 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15979 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15980
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015981ssl_bc_alpn : string
15982 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15983 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015984 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015985 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15986 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15987 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15988 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15989 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15990 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15991
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015992ssl_bc_cipher : string
15993 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15994 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15995
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015996ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15997 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15998 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15999 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16000
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016001ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16002 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16003 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
16004 session or a TLS ticket.
16005
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016006ssl_bc_npn : string
16007 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16008 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016009 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016010 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16011 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16012 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16013 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
16014 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
16015
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016016ssl_bc_protocol : string
16017 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
16018 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16019
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016020ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016021 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016022 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16023 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016024
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016025ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16026 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16027 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16028 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16029
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016030ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16031 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16032 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
16033 if session was reused or not.
16034
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016035ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16036 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16037 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16038 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16039 BoringSSL.
16040
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016041ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16042 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
16043 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016045ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16046 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16047 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16048 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16049 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16050 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016052ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16053 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16054 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16055 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16056 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016057
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016058ssl_c_der : binary
16059 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16060 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16061 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063ssl_c_err : integer
16064 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16065 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16066 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16067 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16068 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016069
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016070ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16072 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16073 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16074 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16075 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16076 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16077 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16078 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016079 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16080 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16081 LDAP v3.
16082 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16083 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085ssl_c_key_alg : string
16086 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16087 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16088 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090ssl_c_notafter : string
16091 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16092 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16093 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095ssl_c_notbefore : string
16096 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16097 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16098 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016099
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016100ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16102 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16103 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16104 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16105 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16106 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16107 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16108 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016109 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16110 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16111 LDAP v3.
16112 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16113 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115ssl_c_serial : binary
16116 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16117 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16118 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16121 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16122 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16123 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016124 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16125 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16126
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016127 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016128 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016130ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16131 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16132 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16133 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016135ssl_c_used : boolean
16136 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16137 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139ssl_c_verify : integer
16140 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16141 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16142 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16143 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145ssl_c_version : integer
16146 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16147 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016148
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016149ssl_f_der : binary
16150 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16151 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16152 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16153
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016154ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16156 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16157 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16158 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016159 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16161 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16162 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016163 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16164 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16165 LDAP v3.
16166 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16167 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169ssl_f_key_alg : string
16170 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16171 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16172 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174ssl_f_notafter : string
16175 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16176 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16177 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179ssl_f_notbefore : string
16180 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16181 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16182 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016183
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016184ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016185 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16186 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16187 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16188 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16189 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16190 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16191 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16192 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016193 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16194 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16195 LDAP v3.
16196 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16197 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016199ssl_f_serial : binary
16200 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16201 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16202 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016203
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016204ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16205 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16206 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16207 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16210 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16211 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16212 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214ssl_f_version : integer
16215 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16216 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16217
16218ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016219 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16220 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16221 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223 Example :
16224 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16225 listen http-https
16226 bind :80
16227 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16228 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16229
16230ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16231 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16232 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16233
16234ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016235 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16237 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16238 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16239 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16240 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16241 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16242 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16243 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245ssl_fc_cipher : string
16246 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16247 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016248
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016249ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16250 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16251 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016252 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016253
16254ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16255 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16256 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016257 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016258
16259ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16260 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16261 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16262 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016263 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016264 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016265
16266ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16267 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16268 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016269 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016270
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016271ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16272 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16273 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16274 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016277 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16278 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016279 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16280 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16281 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16282 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016283
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016284ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16285 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16286 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16287 wait until the handshake happened.
16288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016289ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16290 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016291 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16292 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016293 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016294 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016295
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016296ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016297 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016298 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16299 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016301ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016302 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16304 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16305 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16306 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16307 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16308 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16309 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016311ssl_fc_protocol : string
16312 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16313 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016314
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016315ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016316 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016317 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16318 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016319
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016320ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16321 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16322 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16323 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016325ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16326 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16327 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16328 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16329 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016330
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016331ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16332 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16333 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16334 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16335 BoringSSL.
16336
16337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016338ssl_fc_sni : string
16339 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16340 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16341 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16342 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16343 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16344
16345 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16346 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16347 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016348 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016349 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016351 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016352 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16353 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016355ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16356 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16357 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016358
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016359
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163607.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016361------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16364sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16365only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16366For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16367be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16368can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16369sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16370for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16371content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016373payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016374 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016375 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16376 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016378payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16379 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016380 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016381 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016382
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016383req.hdrs : string
16384 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16385 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16386 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16387 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16388
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016389req.hdrs_bin : binary
16390 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16391 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16392 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16393 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16394 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16395 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16396
16397 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16398
16399 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16400 str: <int:length><bytes>
16401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016402req.len : integer
16403req_len : integer (deprecated)
16404 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16405 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16406 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16407 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16408 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16409 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16410 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16411 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016413req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16414 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016415 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16416 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16417 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16418 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420 ACL alternatives :
16421 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16424 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16425 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16426 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16427 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016429 ACL alternatives :
16430 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016432 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016434req.proto_http : boolean
16435req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16436 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16437 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16438 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16439 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16440 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16441 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16442 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016444 Example:
16445 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16446 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16447 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016448 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016450req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16451rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16452 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16453 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16454 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16455 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16456 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16457 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16458 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016460 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16461 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16462 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16463 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16464 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16465 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016467 ACL derivatives :
16468 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016470 Example :
16471 listen tse-farm
16472 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16473 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16474 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16475 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16476 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16477 persist rdp-cookie
16478 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16479 # This is only useful makes sense if
16480 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16481 stick-table type string size 204800
16482 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16483 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16484 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016486 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16487 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016489req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16490rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16491 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16492 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16493 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16494 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016496 ACL derivatives :
16497 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016498
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016499req.ssl_alpn : string
16500 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16501 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16502 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16503 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16504 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16505 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016506 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016507
16508 Examples :
16509 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16510 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16511 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016512 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016513 default_backend bk_default
16514
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016515req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16516 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16517 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016518 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16519 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16520 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16521 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16522 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016524req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16525req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16526 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16527 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16528 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16529 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16530 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16531 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16532 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016534req.ssl_sni : string
16535req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16536 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16537 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16538 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16539 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16540 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16541 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16542 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16543 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16544 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16545 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16546 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16547 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016549 ACL derivatives :
16550 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016552 Examples :
16553 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16554 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16555 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16556 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16557 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016558
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016559req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16560 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16561 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16562 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16563 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16564 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16565 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16566 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16567 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16568 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016570req.ssl_ver : integer
16571req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16572 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16573 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16574 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16575 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16576 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16577 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16578 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016579 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582 ACL derivatives :
16583 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016584
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016585res.len : integer
16586 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16587 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16588 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16589 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16590 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16591 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16592 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16593 content inspection.
16594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16596 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016597 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16598 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16599 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16600 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016602res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16603 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16604 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16605 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16606 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016608 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016609
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016610res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16611rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16612 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16613 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16614 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16615 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16616 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16617 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16618 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016620wait_end : boolean
16621 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16622 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016623 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016624 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16625 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016626 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016627 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16628 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016630 Examples :
16631 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16632 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16633 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016635 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16636 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16637 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16638 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16639 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16640 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16641 tcp-request content reject
16642
16643
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166447.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016645--------------------------------------
16646
16647It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16648This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16649data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16650its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16651HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16652content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16653to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16654more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16655response are indexed.
16656
16657base : string
16658 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16659 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16660 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16661 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16662 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16663 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16664 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16665 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16666
16667 ACL derivatives :
16668 base : exact string match
16669 base_beg : prefix match
16670 base_dir : subdir match
16671 base_dom : domain match
16672 base_end : suffix match
16673 base_len : length match
16674 base_reg : regex match
16675 base_sub : substring match
16676
16677base32 : integer
16678 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16679 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16680 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016681 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16682 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16683 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016684
16685base32+src : binary
16686 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16687 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16688 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16689 per-URL counters.
16690
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016691capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16692 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16693 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16694 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16695
16696capture.req.method : string
16697 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16698 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16699 because it's allocated.
16700
16701capture.req.uri : string
16702 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16703 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16704 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16705 allocated.
16706
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016707capture.req.ver : string
16708 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16709 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16710 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16711
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016712capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16713 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16714 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16715 The first entry is an index of 0.
16716 See also: "capture response header"
16717
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016718capture.res.ver : string
16719 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16720 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16721 persistent flag.
16722
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016723req.body : binary
16724 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16725 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16726 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16727 the first chunk is analyzed.
16728
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016729req.body_param([<name>) : string
16730 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16731 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16732 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16733 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16734 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16735 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16736 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16737 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16738 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16739 given.
16740
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016741req.body_len : integer
16742 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16743 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16744 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16745 "option http-buffer-request".
16746
16747req.body_size : integer
16748 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16749 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16750 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16751 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16752 "option http-buffer-request".
16753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754req.cook([<name>]) : string
16755cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16756 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16757 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16758 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16759 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16760 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16761 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16762 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16763 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16764
16765 ACL derivatives :
16766 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16767 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16768 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16769 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16770 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16771 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16772 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16773 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16776cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16777 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16778 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016780req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16781cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16782 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16783 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16784 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16785 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016787cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16788 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16789 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16790 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16791 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016792 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016793 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16794 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16795 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16796 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16799 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16800 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16801 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16802 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016803 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016805req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16806 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16807 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16808 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16809 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16810 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16811 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16812 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16813 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16816 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16817 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16818 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16819 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16822 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16823 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16824 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16825 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16826 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16827 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16828 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16829 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016830 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016831 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016832 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016834 ACL derivatives :
16835 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16836 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16837 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16838 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16839 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16840 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16841 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16842 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16843
16844req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16845hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16846 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16847 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16848 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16849 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16850 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16851 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16852 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16853 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16854 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16855
16856req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16857hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16858 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16859 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16860 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16861 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16862 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016863 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16865 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16866
16867req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16868hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16869 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16870 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16871 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16872 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16873 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16874 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16875 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16876
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016877
16878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016879http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16880 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16881 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16882 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16883 basic auth is supported.
16884
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016885http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16886 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16887 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16888 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16889 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16891 basic auth is supported.
16892
16893 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016894 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16895 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16896 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16897 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016898
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016899http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016900 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16901 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16902 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016903
16904http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016905 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16906 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16907 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016908
16909http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016910 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16911 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16912 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016914http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016915 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16916 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016917 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16918 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920method : integer + string
16921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16922 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16923 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16924 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16925 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16926 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16927 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016929 ACL derivatives :
16930 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016932 Example :
16933 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16934 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16935 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016937path : string
16938 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16939 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16940 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16941 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16942 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016943 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016944 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016946 ACL derivatives :
16947 path : exact string match
16948 path_beg : prefix match
16949 path_dir : subdir match
16950 path_dom : domain match
16951 path_end : suffix match
16952 path_len : length match
16953 path_reg : regex match
16954 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016955
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016956query : string
16957 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16958 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16959 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16960 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016961 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016962 which stops before the question mark.
16963
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016964req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16965 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16966 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16967 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16968 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016970req.ver : string
16971req_ver : string (deprecated)
16972 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16973 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16974 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016976 ACL derivatives :
16977 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016979res.comp : boolean
16980 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16981 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16982 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016984res.comp_algo : string
16985 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16986 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16987 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016989res.cook([<name>]) : string
16990scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16991 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16992 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16993 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016995 ACL derivatives :
16996 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016998res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16999scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17000 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17001 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
17002 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017004res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17005scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17006 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17007 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
17008 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017010res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17011 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17012 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17013 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17014 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17015 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17016 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17017 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17018 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
17019 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017021res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17022 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17023 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17024 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17025 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
17026 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017028res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17029shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17030 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17031 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17032 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17033 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17034 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17035 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17036 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
17037 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017039 ACL derivatives :
17040 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17041 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17042 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17043 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17044 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17045 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17046 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17047 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17048
17049res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17050shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17051 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17052 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17053 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17054 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
17055 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017057res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17058shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17059 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17060 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17061 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17062 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17063 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
17064 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017065
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017066res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17067 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17068 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17069 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17070 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017072res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17073shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17074 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17075 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17076 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17077 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17078 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
17079 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017081res.ver : string
17082resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17083 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
17084 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017086 ACL derivatives :
17087 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017089set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17090 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17091 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017092 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017093 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017095 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17096 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098status : integer
17099 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17100 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
17101 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017102
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017103unique-id : string
17104 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17105 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17106 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17107 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17108 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17109 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017111url : string
17112 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17113 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17114 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17115 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17116 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17117 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17118 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017120 ACL derivatives :
17121 url : exact string match
17122 url_beg : prefix match
17123 url_dir : subdir match
17124 url_dom : domain match
17125 url_end : suffix match
17126 url_len : length match
17127 url_reg : regex match
17128 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130url_ip : ip
17131 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17132 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17133 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17134 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17135 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17136 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17137 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017139url_port : integer
17140 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17141 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17142 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17143 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017144
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017145urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17146url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017147 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17148 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017149 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17150 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17151 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17152 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017153 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17154 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017155 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17156 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017158 ACL derivatives :
17159 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17160 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17161 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17162 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17163 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17164 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17165 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17166 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017167
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017169 Example :
17170 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17171 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17172 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17173 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017174
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017175urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017176 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17177 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17178 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017179
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017180url32 : integer
17181 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17182 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17183 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17184 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17185 is an unsigned integer.
17186
17187url32+src : binary
17188 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17189 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17190 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17191
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017192
Christopher Fauletba3c68f2020-04-01 16:27:05 +0200171937.3.7. Fetching health-check samples
17194-------------------------------------
17195
17196This set of sample fetch methods may be called from an health-check execution
17197context. It was introduced in the version 2.2. The following sample fetches are
17198placed in the dedicated scope "check". Other sample fetches may also be called
17199when an health-check is performed if it makes sense and if the sample fetch was
17200adapted to be called in this context.
17201
17202check.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17203 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
17204 in the check input buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is
17205 zero, then the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can
17206 be called from a tcp-check expect rule, or eventually from a set-var rule
17207 after an expect rule and before a send rule (check input buffer is filled on
17208 tcp-check expect rules and reset on tcp-check send rules).
17209
17210
172117.3.8. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017212---------------------------------------
17213
17214This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17215used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17216purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17217There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17218or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17219any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17220for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17221
17222internal.htx.data : integer
17223 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17224 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17225
17226internal.htx.free : integer
17227 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17228 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17229
17230internal.htx.free_data : integer
17231 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17232 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17233
17234internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17235 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17236 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17237 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17238
17239internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17240 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17241 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17242
17243internal.htx.size : integer
17244 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17245 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17246
17247internal.htx.used : integer
17248 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17249 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17250 direction.
17251
17252internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17253 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17254 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17255 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17256 of the special value :
17257 * head : The oldest inserted block
17258 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017259 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017260
17261internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17262 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17263 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17264 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17265 integer or one of the special value :
17266 * head : The oldest inserted block
17267 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017268 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017269
17270internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17271 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17272 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17273 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17274 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17275
17276 * head : The oldest inserted block
17277 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017278 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017279
17280internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17281 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17282 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17283 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17284 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17285
17286 * head : The oldest inserted block
17287 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017288 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017289
17290internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17291 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17292 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17293 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17294 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17295
17296 * head : The oldest inserted block
17297 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017298 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017299
17300internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17301 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17302 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17303 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17304 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17305
17306 * head : The oldest inserted block
17307 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017308 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017309
17310internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17311 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17312 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17313 it returns false.
17314
17315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200173167.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017317---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017319Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17320every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017321order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017323ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17324---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017325FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017326HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017327HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17328HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017329HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17330HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17331HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17332HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17333LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017334METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017335METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017336METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17337METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17338METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17339METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017340METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017341METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017342RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017343REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017344TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017345WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17346---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017347
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173498. Logging
17350----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017351
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017352One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17353provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17354very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17355provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17356state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017357to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017358headers.
17359
17360In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17361about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17362send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17363
17364 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17365 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17366 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17367 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17368 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017369 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017370 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017371
17372The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17373allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17374as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17375while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17376real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17377delay.
17378
17379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173808.1. Log levels
17381---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017382
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017383TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017384source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017385HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17386in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17387track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17388syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17389about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017390
17391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173928.2. Log formats
17393----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017394
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017395HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017396and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17397slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17398options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017399
17400 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17401 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17402 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17403 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17404 extents.
17405
17406 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17407 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17408 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17409 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17410 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17411
17412 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17413 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17414 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17415 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17416 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17417
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017418 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17419 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17420 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17421 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17422
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017423 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17424
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017425Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17426specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17427field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17428servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17429always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17430identifier.
17431
17432Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17433 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17434 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17435 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17436 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17437
17438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174398.2.1. Default log format
17440-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017441
17442This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17443as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17444format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17445
17446 Example :
17447 listen www
17448 mode http
17449 log global
17450 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17451
17452 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17453 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17454 (www/HTTP)
17455
17456 Field Format Extract from the example above
17457 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17458 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17459 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17460 4 'to' to
17461 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17462 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17463
17464Detailed fields description :
17465 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17466 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17467 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17468 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17469 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17470 and processed the connection.
17471 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17472
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017473In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17474"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17475connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17476
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017477It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17478will eventually disappear.
17479
17480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174818.2.2. TCP log format
17482---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483
17484The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17485is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17486information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17487counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17488emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17489environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17490the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17491sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017492specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17493not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17494fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17495marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017496
17497 Example :
17498 frontend fnt
17499 mode tcp
17500 option tcplog
17501 log global
17502 default_backend bck
17503
17504 backend bck
17505 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17506
17507 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17508 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17509 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17510
17511 Field Format Extract from the example above
17512 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17513 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17514 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17515 4 frontend_name fnt
17516 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17517 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17518 7 bytes_read* 212
17519 8 termination_state --
17520 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17521 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17522
17523Detailed fields description :
17524 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017525 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17526 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17527 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017528 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017529 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017530 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017531
17532 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017533 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17534 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17535 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017536
17537 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17538 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17539 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017540 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17541 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17542 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17543 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544
17545 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17546 and processed the connection.
17547
17548 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17549 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17550 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17551 applications.
17552
17553 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17554 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17555 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17556 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17557 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17558
17559 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17560 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17561 See "Timers" below for more details.
17562
17563 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17564 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17565 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17566 "Timers" below for more details.
17567
17568 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017569 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017570 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17571 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17572 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17573 details.
17574
17575 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17576 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17577 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17578 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17579 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17580
17581 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17582 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17583 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17584 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17585 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17586 for more details.
17587
17588 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017589 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017590 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17591 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17592 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017593 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017594
17595 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17596 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17597 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17598 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17599 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17600 caused by a denial of service attack.
17601
17602 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17603 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17604 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17605 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17606 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17607 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17608 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17609 denial of service attack.
17610
17611 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17612 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17613 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17614 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17615 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17616 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17617 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17618 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17619 be processed than on other servers.
17620
17621 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17622 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17623 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17624 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17625 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17626 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17627 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17628 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17629 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17630 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17631 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17632 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17633 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17634
17635 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17636 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17637 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17638 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17639 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17640 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017641 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017642 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17643
17644 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17645 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17646 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17647 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17648 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17649 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017650 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017651 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17652 occurs.
17653
17654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176558.2.3. HTTP log format
17656----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017657
17658The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17659is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17660the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17661are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17662emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17663generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17664"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17665which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017666frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17667is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017668
17669Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17670slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17671with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17672
17673 Example :
17674 frontend http-in
17675 mode http
17676 option httplog
17677 log global
17678 default_backend bck
17679
17680 backend static
17681 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17682
17683 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17684 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17685 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017686 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017687
17688 Field Format Extract from the example above
17689 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17690 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017691 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017692 4 frontend_name http-in
17693 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017694 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017695 7 status_code 200
17696 8 bytes_read* 2750
17697 9 captured_request_cookie -
17698 10 captured_response_cookie -
17699 11 termination_state ----
17700 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17701 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17702 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17703 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17704 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017705
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017706Detailed fields description :
17707 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017708 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17709 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17710 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017711 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017712 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017713 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017714
17715 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017716 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17717 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17718 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017719
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017720 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17721 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017722
17723 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17724 and processed the connection.
17725
17726 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17727 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17728 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17729
17730 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17731 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17732 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17733 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17734 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17735 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17736
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017737 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17738 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17739 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017740 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017741 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17742 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017743 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17744 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017745
17746 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17747 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017748 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017749
17750 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17751 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017752 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17753 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017754
17755 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17756 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17757 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17758 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17759 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017760 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17761 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017762
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017763 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17764 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17765 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17766 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17767 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17768 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17769 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017770 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017771
17772 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17773 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17774 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17775
17776 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17777 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017778 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017779 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17780 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17781 overflowing.
17782
17783 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17784 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17785 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17786 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17787 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17788 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17789 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17790 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17791
17792 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17793 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17794 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17795 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17796 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17797 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17798 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17799 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17800
17801 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17802 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17803 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17804 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17805 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17806 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17807 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17808
17809 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017810 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017811 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17812 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17813 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017814 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017815 system.
17816
17817 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17818 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17819 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17820 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17821 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17822 caused by a denial of service attack.
17823
17824 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17825 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17826 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17827 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17828 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17829 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17830 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17831 denial of service attack.
17832
17833 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17834 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17835 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17836 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17837 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17838 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17839 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17840 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17841 processed than on other servers.
17842
17843 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17844 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17845 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17846 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17847 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17848 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17849 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17850 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17851 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17852 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17853 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17854 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17855 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17856
17857 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17858 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17859 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17860 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17861 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17862 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017863 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017864 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17865
17866 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17867 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17868 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17869 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17870 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17871 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017872 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017873 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17874 occurs.
17875
17876 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17877 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17878 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17879 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17880 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17881 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17882 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17883 cookies" below for more details.
17884
17885 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17886 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17887 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17888 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17889 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17890 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17891 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17892 and cookies" below for more details.
17893
17894 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17895 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17896 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17897 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17898 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17899 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17900 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17901 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17902
17903
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200179048.2.4. Custom log format
17905------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017906
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017907The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017908mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017909
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017910HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017911Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17912separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17913prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17914
17915Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17916variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017917("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017918
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017919If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017920as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017921less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17922the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17923
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017924Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017925In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017926in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017927
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017928Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17929'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17930https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17931such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17932
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017933Flags are :
17934 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017935 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017936 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17937 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017938
17939 Example:
17940
17941 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17942 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17943
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017944 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17945
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017946At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17947
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017948 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17949 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017950
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017951the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017952
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017953 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17954 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17955 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017956
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017957and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17958
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017959 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17960 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017961
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017962Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17963
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017964 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017965 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017966 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17967 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17968 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017969 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17970 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17971 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017972 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017973 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17974 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017975 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017976 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17977 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017978 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017979 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017980 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017981 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017982 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017983 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017984 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017985 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17986 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17987 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17988 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17989 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017990 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017991 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17992 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017993 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017994 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17995 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017996 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17997 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17998 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017999 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018000 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18001 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018002 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018003 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18004 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18005 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018006 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018007 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018008 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18009 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18010 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18011 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018012 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018013 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018014 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018015 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018016 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018017 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018018 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18019 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18020 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018021 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018022 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18023 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018024 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018025 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18026 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018027 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018028 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018029 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018030 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018031
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018032 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018033
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018034
180358.2.5. Error log format
18036-----------------------
18037
18038When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18039protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18040By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18041"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018042will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018043logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18044
18045The format looks like this :
18046
18047 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18048 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18049 Connection error during SSL handshake
18050
18051 Field Format Extract from the example above
18052 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18053 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18054 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18055 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18056 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18057
18058These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18059failures.
18060
18061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180628.3. Advanced logging options
18063-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018064
18065Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18066just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18067options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18068for more information about their usage.
18069
18070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180718.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18072------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018073
18074It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18075haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18076commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18077monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18078ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18079
18080 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18081 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18082 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18083 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18084
18085 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18086 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18087 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018088 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018089 such as other load-balancers.
18090
18091 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18092 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18093 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18094
18095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18097----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018098
18099The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18100what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18101or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018102"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018103just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18104log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18105after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18106is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18107with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18108with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18109
18110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181118.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18112------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018113
18114Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18115for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18116"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18117retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18118raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18119a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18120file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18121you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18122"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18123
18124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181258.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18126--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018127
18128Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18129multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18130them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18131"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18132logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18133error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18134and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18135too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18136useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18137alternative.
18138
18139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181408.4. Timing events
18141------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018142
18143Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18144reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18145the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18146frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018147mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18148addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18149
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018150Timings events in HTTP mode:
18151
18152 first request 2nd request
18153 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18154 t tr t tr ...
18155 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18156 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18157 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18158 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
18159 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18160
18161Timings events in TCP mode:
18162
18163 TCP session
18164 |<----------------->|
18165 t t
18166 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18167 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18168 |<------ Tt ------->|
18169
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018170 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018171 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018172 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18173 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18174 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018175 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018176 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18177 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18178 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18179 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018180
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018181 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18182 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18183 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018184 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18185 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18186 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18187 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18188 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18189 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018190
18191 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18192 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18193 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18194 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18195 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18196 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18197 request typed by hand during a test.
18198
18199 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18200 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018201 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018202 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18203 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18204 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18205 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018206
18207 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18208 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18209 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18210 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18211 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18212
18213 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18214 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18215 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18216 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18217 connection never established.
18218
18219 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18220 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18221 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18222 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18223 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18224 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18225 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18226 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18227 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18228 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18229 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18230
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018231 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18232 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18233 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18234 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18235 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18236 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18237
18238 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18239
18240 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18241 "Ta" can never be negative.
18242
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018243 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18244 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018245 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18246 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018247 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018248
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018249 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018250
18251 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018252 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18253 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018254
18255These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18256protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18257that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018258due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18259"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18260that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018261
18262Most common cases :
18263
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018264 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18265 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18266 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18267 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18268 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18269 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18270 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18271 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18272 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18273 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18274 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018275 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018276
18277 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18278 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18279 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18280 of ms on remote networks.
18281
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018282 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18283 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18284 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018285
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018286 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18287 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18288 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18289 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18290 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18291 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18292 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18293 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18294 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018295
18296Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18297
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018298 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018299 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018300 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018301
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018302 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018303 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18304 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18305
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018306 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018307 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18308 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18309 flags.
18310
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018311 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18312 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018313 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18314 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18315 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18316 the client connection was maintained open.
18317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018318 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018319 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018320 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018321 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18322
18323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183248.5. Session state at disconnection
18325-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018326
18327TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18328"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
183292-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18330each of which has a special meaning :
18331
18332 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18333 session to terminate :
18334
18335 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18336
18337 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18338 server explicitly refused it.
18339
18340 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18341 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18342 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18343 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018344 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018345
18346 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18347 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018348
18349 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18350 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18351 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18352 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18353 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18354
18355 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18356 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18357 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18358 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18359 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18360
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018361 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18362 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18363
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018364 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18365 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18366 backup connections when going up.
18367
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018368 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18369
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018370 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18371 send or receive data.
18372
18373 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18374 send or receive data.
18375
18376 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18377 with nothing left in the buffers.
18378
18379 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18380
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018381 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018382 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18383
18384 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18385 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18386 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18387 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18388 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18389
18390 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18391 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18392
18393 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18394 server (HTTP only).
18395
18396 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18397
18398 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18399 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18400 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18401
18402 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18403 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18404 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18405
18406 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18407
18408 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18409 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18410
18411 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18412 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18413 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18414
18415 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18416 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018417 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18418 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018419
18420 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18421 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18422 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18423 another server.
18424
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018425 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018426 server.
18427
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018428 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18429 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18430 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18431 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18432
18433 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18434 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18435 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18436 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18437
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018438 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18439 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18440 "use-server" rule).
18441
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018442 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18443
18444 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18445 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18446
18447 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18448
18449 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18450 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18451 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18452
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018453 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18454 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018455 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018456 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18457 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018459 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18460
18461 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18462 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18463
18464 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18465
18466 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18467
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018468The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18469was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018470helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18471starvation, attacks, etc...
18472
18473The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18474alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18475easier finding and understanding.
18476
18477 Flags Reason
18478
18479 -- Normal termination.
18480
18481 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18482 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18483 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18484 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18485
18486 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18487 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18488 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18489 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18490 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18491 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018492
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018493 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18494 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018495 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018496
18497 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18498 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18499 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18500
18501 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18502 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18503 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18504 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18505 the server takes too long to respond.
18506
18507 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18508 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18509 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18510 long a time to respond.
18511
18512 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18513 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18514 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18515 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018516 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18517 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018518
18519 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18520 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18521 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18522 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18523 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018524 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018525 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18526 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18527 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18528 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18529 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18530 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18531 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18532 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018533 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018534 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18535 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18536 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018537
18538 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18539 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018540 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18541 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18542 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18543 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018544
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018545 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18546 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18547
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018548 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018549 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18550 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018551 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018552 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18553 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18554
18555 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18556 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18557 503 or 504 here.
18558
18559 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18560 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18561 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18562 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18563 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18564
18565 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18566 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018567 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018568 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18569 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18570
18571 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18572 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18573 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18574 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18575 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18576 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18577 between haproxy and the server.
18578
18579 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18580 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18581 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18582 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18583 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18584 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18585 solution is to fix the application.
18586
18587 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18588 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18589 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18590 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18591 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18592 external attacks.
18593
18594 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18595 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018596 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018597 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18598 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18599
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018600 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18601 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18602 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018603 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018604 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018605
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018606 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18607 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18608 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18609 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018610 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18611 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18612 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18613 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18614 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018615
18616 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18617 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18618 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18619 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18620
18621 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18622 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18623 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18624 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18625
18626 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18627 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18628 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18629 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18630
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018631The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18632persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18633important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18634re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18635
18636 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18637
18638 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18639 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18640 set on a GET request.
18641
18642 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18643 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018644 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018645 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18646
18647 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18648 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18649 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18650
18651 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18652 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18653 already got a cookie.
18654
18655 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18656 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18657 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18658 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18659 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18660
18661 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18662 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18663 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18664
18665 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18666 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18667 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18668
18669 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18670 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18671
18672 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18673 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18674 then advertised in the response.
18675
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186778.6. Non-printable characters
18678-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018679
18680In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18681consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18682converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18683prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18684being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18685escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18686is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18687'}' when logging headers.
18688
18689Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18690issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18691containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18692
18693Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18694the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18695performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18696
18697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18699---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018700
18701Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18702achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018703section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018704cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18705the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18706the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018707locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018708not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18709user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18710a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18711wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18712
18713 Examples :
18714 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18715 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18716
18717 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18718 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18719
18720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187218.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18722---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018723
18724Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18725proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18726the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18727server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18728
18729Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18730response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018731section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018732
18733It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018734time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18735appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018736are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18737and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18738follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18739request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18740in the logs.
18741
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018742As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18743frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18744an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18745
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018746 Example :
18747 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18748 listen proxy-out
18749 mode http
18750 option httplog
18751 option logasap
18752 log global
18753 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18754
18755 # log the name of the virtual server
18756 capture request header Host len 20
18757
18758 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18759 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18760
18761 # log the beginning of the referrer
18762 capture request header Referer len 20
18763
18764 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18765 capture response header Server len 20
18766
18767 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18768 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018770 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018771 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18772
18773 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18774 capture response header Via len 20
18775
18776 # log the URL location during a redirection
18777 capture response header Location len 20
18778
18779 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18780 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18781 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18782 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18783 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18784
18785 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18786 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18787 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18788 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018789 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018790
18791 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18792 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18793 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18794 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18795 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018796 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018797
18798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187998.9. Examples of logs
18800---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018801
18802These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18803them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18804reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18805
18806 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18807 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18808 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18809
18810 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18811 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18812
18813 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18814 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18815 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18816
18817 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18818 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18819
18820 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18821 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18822 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18823
18824 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018825 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018826 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18827 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18828
18829 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18830 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18831 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18832
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018833 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18834 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18835 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18836 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18837 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18838 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018839
18840 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018841 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018842
18843 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18844 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18845 Nothing was sent to any server.
18846
18847 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18848 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18849
18850 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18851 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018852 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018853 send a 408 return code to the client.
18854
18855 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18856 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18857
18858 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18859 5 seconds ("c----").
18860
18861 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18862 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018863 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018864
18865 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018866 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018867 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18868 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18869 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18870 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18871 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018872
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018873
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200188749. Supported filters
18875--------------------
18876
18877Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18878accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18879unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18880
18881See also : "filter"
18882
188839.1. Trace
18884----------
18885
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018886filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018887
18888 Arguments:
18889 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18890 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18891
18892 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18893 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18894 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18895 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18896
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018897 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018898 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18899 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18900 amount of the parsed data.
18901
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018902 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018903
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018904This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18905callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18906information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18907filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18908
18909Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18910tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18911a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18912
18913
189149.2. HTTP compression
18915---------------------
18916
18917filter compression
18918
18919The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18920keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018921when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18922fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18923done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18924explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18925filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18926listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18927order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018928
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018929See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18930 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018931
18932
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200189339.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18934--------------------------------------------
18935
18936filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18937
18938 Arguments :
18939
18940 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18941 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18942 parsed.
18943
18944 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18945 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18946 part must be placed in its own scope.
18947
18948The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18949external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018950streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018951exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18952also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18953
18954SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18955the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18956
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018957For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018958"doc/SPOE.txt".
18959
18960Important note:
18961 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18962 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18963
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100189649.4. Cache
18965----------
18966
18967filter cache <name>
18968
18969 Arguments :
18970
18971 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18972
18973The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18974"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018975cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018976other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18977case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18978is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18979filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018980listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18981order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018982
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018983See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18984 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18985
18986
189879.5. Fcgi-app
18988-------------
18989
18990filter fcg-app <name>
18991
18992 Arguments :
18993
18994 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18995
18996The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18997request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18998reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18999used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19000implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19001used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19002fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19003used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19004order.
19005
19006See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19007 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19008
19009
1901010. FastCGI applications
19011-------------------------
19012
19013HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19014feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19015the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19016FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19017servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19018FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19019backend.
19020
19021HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19022application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19023connection.
19024
1902510.1. Setup
19026-----------
19027
1902810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19029--------------------------
19030
19031fcgi-app <name>
19032 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19033 document root must be defined.
19034
19035acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19036 Declare or complete an access list.
19037
19038 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19039 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19040 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19041 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19042 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19043
19044docroot <path>
19045 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19046 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19047 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19048
19049index <script-name>
19050 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19051 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19052 is an optional setting.
19053
19054 Example :
19055 index index.php
19056
19057log-stderr global
19058log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19059 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19060 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19061
19062 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19063 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19064
19065pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19066 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19067 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19068 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19069
19070 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19071 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19072 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19073 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19074
19075 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19076 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19077
19078path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019079 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019080 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19081 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19082 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19083 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19084 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19085 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19086 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019087
19088 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019089 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019090 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19091 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19092 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19093 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019094
19095 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019096 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19097 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019098
19099option get-values
19100no option get-values
19101 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19102
19103 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19104 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19105
19106 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19107 application will accept.
19108
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019109 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19110 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019111
19112 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19113 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19114 option is disabled.
19115
19116 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19117 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19118 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19119 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19120 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19121 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19122
19123option keep-conn
19124no option keep-conn
19125 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19126 sending a response.
19127
19128 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19129 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19130
19131option max-reqs <reqs>
19132 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19133 accept.
19134
19135 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19136 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19137 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19138 to 1.
19139
19140option mpxs-conns
19141no option mpxs-conns
19142 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19143
19144 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19145 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19146
19147set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19148 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19149 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19150 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19151 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19152
19153 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19154 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19155 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19156
19157 Example :
19158 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19159 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19160
19161 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19162
19163
1916410.1.2. Proxy section
19165---------------------
19166
19167use-fcgi-app <name>
19168 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19169
19170 Arguments :
19171 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19172
19173 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19174 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19175 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19176 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19177 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19178
19179 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19180 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19181 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19182 application are evaluated.
19183
19184
1918510.1.3. Example
19186---------------
19187
19188 frontend front-http
19189 mode http
19190 bind *:80
19191 bind *:
19192
19193 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19194 default_backend back-static
19195
19196 backend back-static
19197 mode http
19198 server www A.B.C.D:80
19199
19200 backend back-dynamic
19201 mode http
19202 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19203 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19204
19205 fcgi-app php-fpm
19206 log-stderr global
19207 option keep-conn
19208
19209 docroot /var/www/my-app
19210 index index.php
19211 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19212
19213
1921410.2. Default parameters
19215------------------------
19216
19217A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19218the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019219script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019220applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19221
19222 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19223 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19224 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19225 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19226 | | |
19227 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19228 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19229 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19230 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19231 | | application. |
19232 | | |
19233 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19234 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19235 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19236 | | |
19237 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19238 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19239 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19240 | | the application's configuration. |
19241 | | |
19242 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19243 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19244 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19245 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19246 | | |
19247 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19248 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19249 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19250 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19251 | | be defined. |
19252 | | |
19253 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19254 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19255 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19256 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19257 | | is not set too. |
19258 | | |
19259 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19260 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19261 | | set. |
19262 | | |
19263 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19264 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19265 | | the request. |
19266 | | |
19267 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19268 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19269 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19270 | | |
19271 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19272 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19273 | | script to process the request. |
19274 | | |
19275 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19276 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19277 | | |
19278 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19279 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19280 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19281 | | |
19282 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19283 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19284 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19285 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19286 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19287 | | |
19288 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19289 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19290 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19291 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19292 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19293 | | side. |
19294 | | |
19295 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19296 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19297 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19298 | | connected to. |
19299 | | |
19300 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19301 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19302 | | |
19303 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19304 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19305 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19306 | | |
19307 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19308
19309
1931010.3. Limitations
19311------------------
19312
19313The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19314way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19315during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19316establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19317application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19318or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19319message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19320these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19321and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19322
19323Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19324request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19325requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19326
19327About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19328into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19329fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19330"http-request" ones.
19331
19332Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19333FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19334processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19335must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19336here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019337
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019338/*
19339 * Local variables:
19340 * fill-column: 79
19341 * End:
19342 */